2006-11-14 Maxim Grigoriev <maxim@tensilica.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
501 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
502 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
503 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
504
505 @node Sample Session
506 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
507
508 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
509 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
510 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
511
512 @iftex
513 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
514 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
515 @end iftex
516
517 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
518 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
519
520 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
521 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
522 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
523 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
524 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
525 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
526 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
527 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
528 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
529
530 @smallexample
531 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
532 $ @b{./m4}
533 @b{define(foo,0000)}
534
535 @b{foo}
536 0000
537 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
538
539 @b{bar}
540 0000
541 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
542
543 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
544 @b{baz}
545 @b{Ctrl-d}
546 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
547 @end smallexample
548
549 @noindent
550 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
551
552 @smallexample
553 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
554 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
555 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
556 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
557 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
558 the conditions.
559 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
560 for details.
561
562 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
563 (@value{GDBP})
564 @end smallexample
565
566 @noindent
567 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
568 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
569 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
570 that examples fit in this manual.
571
572 @smallexample
573 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
574 @end smallexample
575
576 @noindent
577 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
578 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
579 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
580 @code{break} command.
581
582 @smallexample
583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
584 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
589 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
590 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
591
592 @smallexample
593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
594 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
595 @b{define(foo,0000)}
596
597 @b{foo}
598 0000
599 @end smallexample
600
601 @noindent
602 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
603 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
604 context where it stops.
605
606 @smallexample
607 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
608
609 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
610 at builtin.c:879
611 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
612 @end smallexample
613
614 @noindent
615 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
616 the next line of the current function.
617
618 @smallexample
619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
620 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
621 : nil,
622 @end smallexample
623
624 @noindent
625 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
626 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
627 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
628 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
629
630 @smallexample
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
632 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
633 at input.c:530
634 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
635 @end smallexample
636
637 @noindent
638 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
639 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
640 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
641 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
642 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
643 stack frame for each active subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
647 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
648 at input.c:530
649 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
650 at builtin.c:882
651 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
652 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
653 at macro.c:71
654 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
655 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
660 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
661 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
665 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
668 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
670 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
671 : xstrdup(rq);
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
673 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
678 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
679 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
680 (@code{print}) to see their values.
681
682 @smallexample
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
684 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
686 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
691 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
692 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
696 533 xfree(rquote);
697 534
698 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
699 : xstrdup (lq);
700 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
701 : xstrdup (rq);
702 537
703 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
704 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
705 540 @}
706 541
707 542 void
708 @end smallexample
709
710 @noindent
711 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
712 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
713
714 @smallexample
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
716 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 540 @}
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
720 $3 = 9
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
722 $4 = 7
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
727 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
728 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
729 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
730 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
731 assignments.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
735 $5 = 7
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
737 $6 = 9
738 @end smallexample
739
740 @noindent
741 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
742 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
743 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
744 example that caused trouble initially:
745
746 @smallexample
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
748 Continuing.
749
750 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
751
752 baz
753 0000
754 @end smallexample
755
756 @noindent
757 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
758 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
759 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
760
761 @smallexample
762 @b{Ctrl-d}
763 Program exited normally.
764 @end smallexample
765
766 @noindent
767 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
768 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
769 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
770
771 @smallexample
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
773 @end smallexample
774
775 @node Invocation
776 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
777
778 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
779 The essentials are:
780 @itemize @bullet
781 @item
782 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
783 @item
784 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
785 @end itemize
786
787 @menu
788 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
789 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
790 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
791 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
792 @end menu
793
794 @node Invoking GDB
795 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
796
797 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
798 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
799
800 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
801 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
802
803 The command-line options described here are designed
804 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
805 options may effectively be unavailable.
806
807 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
808 specifying an executable program:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @noindent
815 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
816 specified:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
823 to debug a running process:
824
825 @smallexample
826 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
827 @end smallexample
828
829 @noindent
830 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
831 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
832
833 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
834 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
835 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
836 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
837 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
838
839 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
840 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
841 option processing.
842 @smallexample
843 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
844 @end smallexample
845 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
846 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
847
848 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
849 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
850
851 @smallexample
852 @value{GDBP} -silent
853 @end smallexample
854
855 @noindent
856 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
857 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
858
859 @noindent
860 Type
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -help
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
868 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
869
870 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
871 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
872 @samp{-x} option is used.
873
874
875 @menu
876 * File Options:: Choosing files
877 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
878 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
879 @end menu
880
881 @node File Options
882 @subsection Choosing files
883
884 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
885 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
886 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
887 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
888 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
889 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
890 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
892 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
893 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
894 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
895 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
896 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
897
898 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
899 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
900 argument and ignore it.
901
902 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
903 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
904 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
905 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
906 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
907
908 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
909 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
910 @c it.
911
912 @table @code
913 @item -symbols @var{file}
914 @itemx -s @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--symbols}
916 @cindex @code{-s}
917 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
918
919 @item -exec @var{file}
920 @itemx -e @var{file}
921 @cindex @code{--exec}
922 @cindex @code{-e}
923 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
924 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
925
926 @item -se @var{file}
927 @cindex @code{--se}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
929 file.
930
931 @item -core @var{file}
932 @itemx -c @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--core}
934 @cindex @code{-c}
935 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
936
937 @item -c @var{number}
938 @item -pid @var{number}
939 @itemx -p @var{number}
940 @cindex @code{--pid}
941 @cindex @code{-p}
942 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
943 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
944 file named @var{number}.
945
946 @item -command @var{file}
947 @itemx -x @var{file}
948 @cindex @code{--command}
949 @cindex @code{-x}
950 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
951 Files,, Command files}.
952
953 @item -eval-command @var{command}
954 @itemx -ex @var{command}
955 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
956 @cindex @code{-ex}
957 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
958
959 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
960 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
961
962 @smallexample
963 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
964 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
965 @end smallexample
966
967 @item -directory @var{directory}
968 @itemx -d @var{directory}
969 @cindex @code{--directory}
970 @cindex @code{-d}
971 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
972
973 @item -r
974 @itemx -readnow
975 @cindex @code{--readnow}
976 @cindex @code{-r}
977 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
978 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
979 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
980
981 @end table
982
983 @node Mode Options
984 @subsection Choosing modes
985
986 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
987 batch mode or quiet mode.
988
989 @table @code
990 @item -nx
991 @itemx -n
992 @cindex @code{--nx}
993 @cindex @code{-n}
994 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
995 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
996 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
997 files}.
998
999 @item -quiet
1000 @itemx -silent
1001 @itemx -q
1002 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1003 @cindex @code{--silent}
1004 @cindex @code{-q}
1005 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1006 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1007
1008 @item -batch
1009 @cindex @code{--batch}
1010 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1011 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1012 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1013 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1014 in the command files.
1015
1016 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1017 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1018 make this more useful, the message
1019
1020 @smallexample
1021 Program exited normally.
1022 @end smallexample
1023
1024 @noindent
1025 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1026 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1027 mode.
1028
1029 @item -batch-silent
1030 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1031 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1032 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1033 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1034 for an interactive session.
1035
1036 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1037 messages, for example.
1038
1039 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1040 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1041
1042 @item -return-child-result
1043 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1044 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1045 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1046
1047 @itemize @bullet
1048 @item
1049 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1050 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1051 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1052 @item
1053 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1054 @item
1055 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1056 the exit code will be -1.
1057 @end itemize
1058
1059 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1060 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1061 interface.
1062
1063 @item -nowindows
1064 @itemx -nw
1065 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1066 @cindex @code{-nw}
1067 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1068 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1069 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1070
1071 @item -windows
1072 @itemx -w
1073 @cindex @code{--windows}
1074 @cindex @code{-w}
1075 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1076 used if possible.
1077
1078 @item -cd @var{directory}
1079 @cindex @code{--cd}
1080 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1081 instead of the current directory.
1082
1083 @item -fullname
1084 @itemx -f
1085 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1086 @cindex @code{-f}
1087 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1088 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1089 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1090 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1091 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1092 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1093 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1094 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1095 frame.
1096
1097 @item -epoch
1098 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1099 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1100 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1101 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1102 separate window.
1103
1104 @item -annotate @var{level}
1105 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1106 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1107 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1108 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1109 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1110 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1111 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1112 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1113 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1114
1115 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1116 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1117
1118 @item --args
1119 @cindex @code{--args}
1120 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1121 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1122 This option stops option processing.
1123
1124 @item -baud @var{bps}
1125 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1126 @cindex @code{--baud}
1127 @cindex @code{-b}
1128 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1129 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -l @var{timeout}
1132 @cindex @code{-l}
1133 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1134 for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -tty @var{device}
1137 @itemx -t @var{device}
1138 @cindex @code{--tty}
1139 @cindex @code{-t}
1140 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1141 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1142
1143 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1144 @item -tui
1145 @cindex @code{--tui}
1146 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1147 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1148 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1149 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1150 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1151 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1152 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1153
1154 @c @item -xdb
1155 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1156 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1157 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1158 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1159 @c systems.
1160
1161 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1162 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1163 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1164 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1165 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1166 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1167
1168 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1169 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1170 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1171 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1172 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1173 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1174
1175 @item -write
1176 @cindex @code{--write}
1177 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1178 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1179 (@pxref{Patching}).
1180
1181 @item -statistics
1182 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1184 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1185
1186 @item -version
1187 @cindex @code{--version}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1189 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1190
1191 @end table
1192
1193 @node Startup
1194 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1195 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1196
1197 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1198
1199 @enumerate
1200 @item
1201 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1202 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1203
1204 @item
1205 @cindex init file
1206 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1207 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1208 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1209 that file.
1210
1211 @item
1212 Processes command line options and operands.
1213
1214 @item
1215 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1216 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1217 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1218 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1219 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1220 @value{GDBN}.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1224 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1228 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1229 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1230 @end enumerate
1231
1232 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1233 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1234 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1235 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1236 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1237 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1238
1239 @cindex init file name
1240 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1241 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1242 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1243 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1244 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1245 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1246 environments with special init file names:
1247
1248 @itemize @bullet
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 @item
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1258 @item
1259 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1260
1261 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1262 @item
1263 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1264
1265 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1266 @item
1267 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1268
1269 @item
1270 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1271 @end itemize
1272
1273
1274 @node Quitting GDB
1275 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1276 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1277 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1278
1279 @table @code
1280 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1281 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1282 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @itemx q
1284 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1285 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1286 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1287 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1288 error code.
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @cindex interrupt
1292 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1293 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1294 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1295 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1296 until a time when it is safe.
1297
1298 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1299 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1300 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1301
1302 @node Shell Commands
1303 @section Shell commands
1304
1305 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1306 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1307 just use the @code{shell} command.
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex shell
1311 @cindex shell escape
1312 @item shell @var{command string}
1313 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1314 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1315 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1316 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1317 @end table
1318
1319 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1320 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1321 @value{GDBN}:
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex make
1325 @cindex calling make
1326 @item make @var{make-args}
1327 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1328 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1329 @end table
1330
1331 @node Logging output
1332 @section Logging output
1333 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1334 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1335
1336 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1337 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex set logging
1341 @item set logging on
1342 Enable logging.
1343 @item set logging off
1344 Disable logging.
1345 @cindex logging file name
1346 @item set logging file @var{file}
1347 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1348 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1350 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1351 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1352 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1353 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1354 @kindex show logging
1355 @item show logging
1356 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1357 @end table
1358
1359 @node Commands
1360 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1361
1362 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1363 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1364 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1365 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1366 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1367
1368 @menu
1369 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1370 * Completion:: Command completion
1371 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1372 @end menu
1373
1374 @node Command Syntax
1375 @section Command syntax
1376
1377 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1378 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1379 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1380 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1381 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1382 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1383
1384 @cindex abbreviation
1385 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1386 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1387 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1388 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1389 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1390 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1391 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1392
1393 @cindex repeating commands
1394 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1395 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1396 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1397 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1398 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1399 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1400 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1401
1402 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1403 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1404 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1405
1406 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1407 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1408 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1409 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1410 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1411
1412 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1413 @cindex comment
1414 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1415 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1416 Files,,Command files}).
1417
1418 @cindex repeating command sequences
1419 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1420 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1421 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1422 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1423 for editing.
1424
1425 @node Completion
1426 @section Command completion
1427
1428 @cindex completion
1429 @cindex word completion
1430 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1431 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1432 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1433 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1434
1435 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1436 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1437 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1438 enter it). For example, if you type
1439
1440 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1441 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1442 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1443 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1444 @smallexample
1445 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1446 @end smallexample
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1450 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1454 @end smallexample
1455
1456 @noindent
1457 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1458 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1459 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1460 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1461 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1462 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1463
1464 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1465 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1466 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1467 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1468 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1469 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1470 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1471 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1472 example:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1476 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1477 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1478 make_abs_section make_function_type
1479 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1480 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1481 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1483 @end smallexample
1484
1485 @noindent
1486 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1487 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1488 command.
1489
1490 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1491 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1492 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1493 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1494 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1495
1496 @cindex quotes in commands
1497 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1498 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1499 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1500 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1501 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1502 @value{GDBN} commands.
1503
1504 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1505 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1506 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1507 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1508 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1509 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1510 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1511 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1512 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1513 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1514 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1518 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1520 @end smallexample
1521
1522 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1523 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1524 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1525 place:
1526
1527 @smallexample
1528 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1529 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1531 @end smallexample
1532
1533 @noindent
1534 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1535 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1536 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1537
1538 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1539 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1540 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1541 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1542
1543
1544 @node Help
1545 @section Getting help
1546 @cindex online documentation
1547 @kindex help
1548
1549 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1550 using the command @code{help}.
1551
1552 @table @code
1553 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1554 @item help
1555 @itemx h
1556 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1557 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) help
1561 List of classes of commands:
1562
1563 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1564 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1565 data -- Examining data
1566 files -- Specifying and examining files
1567 internals -- Maintenance commands
1568 obscure -- Obscure features
1569 running -- Running the program
1570 stack -- Examining the stack
1571 status -- Status inquiries
1572 support -- Support facilities
1573 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1574 stopping the program
1575 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1576
1577 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1578 commands in that class.
1579 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1580 documentation.
1581 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1582 (@value{GDBP})
1583 @end smallexample
1584 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1585
1586 @item help @var{class}
1587 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1588 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1589 help display for the class @code{status}:
1590
1591 @smallexample
1592 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1593 Status inquiries.
1594
1595 List of commands:
1596
1597 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1598 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1599 info -- Generic command for showing things
1600 about the program being debugged
1601 show -- Generic command for showing things
1602 about the debugger
1603
1604 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1605 documentation.
1606 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1607 (@value{GDBP})
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 @item help @var{command}
1611 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1612 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1613
1614 @kindex apropos
1615 @item apropos @var{args}
1616 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1617 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1618 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 apropos reload
1622 @end smallexample
1623
1624 @noindent
1625 results in:
1626
1627 @smallexample
1628 @c @group
1629 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1630 multiple times in one run
1631 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1632 multiple times in one run
1633 @c @end group
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @kindex complete
1637 @item complete @var{args}
1638 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1639 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1640 command you want completed. For example:
1641
1642 @smallexample
1643 complete i
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 @noindent results in:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 @group
1650 if
1651 ignore
1652 info
1653 inspect
1654 @end group
1655 @end smallexample
1656
1657 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1658 @end table
1659
1660 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1661 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1662 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1663 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1664 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1665 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1666
1667 @c @group
1668 @table @code
1669 @kindex info
1670 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1671 @item info
1672 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1673 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1674 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1675 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1676 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1677 @w{@code{help info}}.
1678
1679 @kindex set
1680 @item set
1681 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1682 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1683 @code{set prompt $}.
1684
1685 @kindex show
1686 @item show
1687 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1688 @value{GDBN} itself.
1689 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1690 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1691 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1692 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1693
1694 @kindex info set
1695 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1696 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1697 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1698 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1699 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1700 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1701 @end table
1702 @c @end group
1703
1704 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1705 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1706
1707 @table @code
1708 @kindex show version
1709 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1710 @item show version
1711 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1712 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1713 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1714 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1715 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1716 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1717 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1718 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1719 @value{GDBN}.
1720
1721 @kindex show copying
1722 @kindex info copying
1723 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1724 @item show copying
1725 @itemx info copying
1726 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1727
1728 @kindex show warranty
1729 @kindex info warranty
1730 @item show warranty
1731 @itemx info warranty
1732 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1733 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1734
1735 @end table
1736
1737 @node Running
1738 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1739
1740 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1741 debugging information when you compile it.
1742
1743 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1744 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1745 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1746 kill a child process.
1747
1748 @menu
1749 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1750 * Starting:: Starting your program
1751 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1752 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1753
1754 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1755 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1756 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1757 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1758
1759 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1760 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1761 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1762 @end menu
1763
1764 @node Compilation
1765 @section Compiling for debugging
1766
1767 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1768 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1769 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1770 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1771 and addresses in the executable code.
1772
1773 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1774 the compiler.
1775
1776 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1777 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1778 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1779 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1780 executables containing debugging information.
1781
1782 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1783 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1784 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1785 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1786 in pushing your luck.
1787
1788 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1789 @cindex debugging optimized code
1790 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1791 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1792 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1793 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1794 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1795 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1796
1797 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1798 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1799 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1800 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1801 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1802
1803 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1804 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1805 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1806
1807 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1808 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1809 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1810 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1811 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1812 provides macro information if you specify the options
1813 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1814 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1815 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1816 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1817 @option{-g} alone.
1818
1819 @need 2000
1820 @node Starting
1821 @section Starting your program
1822 @cindex starting
1823 @cindex running
1824
1825 @table @code
1826 @kindex run
1827 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1828 @item run
1829 @itemx r
1830 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1831 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1832 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1833 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1834 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1835
1836 @end table
1837
1838 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1839 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1840 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1841 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1842
1843 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1844 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1845 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1846 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1847 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1848 divided into four categories:
1849
1850 @table @asis
1851 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1852 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1853 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1854 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1855 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1856 the arguments.
1857 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1858 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1859 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1860
1861 @item The @emph{environment.}
1862 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1863 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1864 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1865 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1868 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1869 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1870 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1871
1872 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1873 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1874 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1875 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1876 set a different device for your program.
1877 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1878
1879 @cindex pipes
1880 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1881 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1882 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1883 wrong program.
1884 @end table
1885
1886 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1887 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1888 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1889 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1890 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1891
1892 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1893 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1894 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1895 your current breakpoints.
1896
1897 @table @code
1898 @kindex start
1899 @item start
1900 @cindex run to main procedure
1901 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1902 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1903 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1904 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1905 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1906 procedure, depending on the language used.
1907
1908 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1909 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1910 the @samp{run} command.
1911
1912 @cindex elaboration phase
1913 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1914 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1915 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1916 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1917 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1918 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1919 will remain to halt execution.
1920
1921 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1922 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1923 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1924 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1925 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1926
1927 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1928 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1929 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1930 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1931 elaboration code before running your program.
1932 @end table
1933
1934 @node Arguments
1935 @section Your program's arguments
1936
1937 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1938 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1939 @code{run} command.
1940 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1941 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1942 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1943 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1944 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1945
1946 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1947 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1948 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1949 the program, not by the shell.
1950
1951 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1952 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1953
1954 @table @code
1955 @kindex set args
1956 @item set args
1957 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1958 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1959 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1960 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1961 it again without arguments.
1962
1963 @kindex show args
1964 @item show args
1965 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 @node Environment
1969 @section Your program's environment
1970
1971 @cindex environment (of your program)
1972 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1973 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1974 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1975 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1976 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1977 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1978 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1979
1980 @table @code
1981 @kindex path
1982 @item path @var{directory}
1983 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1984 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1985 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1986 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1987 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1988 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1989 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1990
1991 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1992 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1993 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1994 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1995 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1996 @var{directory} to the search path.
1997 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1998 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1999
2000 @kindex show paths
2001 @item show paths
2002 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2003 environment variable).
2004
2005 @kindex show environment
2006 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2007 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2008 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2009 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2010 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2011
2012 @kindex set environment
2013 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2014 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2015 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2016 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2017 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2018 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2019 null value.
2020 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2021 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2022
2023 For example, this command:
2024
2025 @smallexample
2026 set env USER = foo
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2031 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2032 are not actually required.)
2033
2034 @kindex unset environment
2035 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2036 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2037 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2038 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2039 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2040 @end table
2041
2042 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2043 the shell indicated
2044 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2045 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2046 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2047 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2048 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2049 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2050 @file{.profile}.
2051
2052 @node Working Directory
2053 @section Your program's working directory
2054
2055 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2056 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2057 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2058 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2059 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2060 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2061
2062 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2063 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2064 specify files}.
2065
2066 @table @code
2067 @kindex cd
2068 @cindex change working directory
2069 @item cd @var{directory}
2070 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2071
2072 @kindex pwd
2073 @item pwd
2074 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2075 @end table
2076
2077 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2078 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2079 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2080 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2081 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2082 current working directory of the debuggee.
2083
2084 @node Input/Output
2085 @section Your program's input and output
2086
2087 @cindex redirection
2088 @cindex i/o
2089 @cindex terminal
2090 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2091 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2092 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2093 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2094 running your program.
2095
2096 @table @code
2097 @kindex info terminal
2098 @item info terminal
2099 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2100 program is using.
2101 @end table
2102
2103 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2104 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2105
2106 @smallexample
2107 run > outfile
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 @noindent
2111 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2112
2113 @kindex tty
2114 @cindex controlling terminal
2115 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2116 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2117 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2118 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2119 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2120
2121 @smallexample
2122 tty /dev/ttyb
2123 @end smallexample
2124
2125 @noindent
2126 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2127 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2128 that as their controlling terminal.
2129
2130 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2131 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2132 terminal.
2133
2134 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2135 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2136 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2137 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2138
2139 @cindex inferior tty
2140 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2141 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2142 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2143 program.
2144
2145 @table @code
2146 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2147 @kindex set inferior-tty
2148 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2149
2150 @item show inferior-tty
2151 @kindex show inferior-tty
2152 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2153 @end table
2154
2155 @node Attach
2156 @section Debugging an already-running process
2157 @kindex attach
2158 @cindex attach
2159
2160 @table @code
2161 @item attach @var{process-id}
2162 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2163 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2164 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2165 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2166 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2167
2168 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2169 executing the command.
2170 @end table
2171
2172 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2173 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2174 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2175 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2176
2177 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2178 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2179 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2180 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2181 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2182 Specify Files}.
2183
2184 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2185 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2186 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2187 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2188 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2189 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2190 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex detach
2194 @item detach
2195 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2196 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2197 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2198 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2199 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2200 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2201 executing the command.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2205 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2206 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2207 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2208 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2209 messages}).
2210
2211 @node Kill Process
2212 @section Killing the child process
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex kill
2216 @item kill
2217 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2218 @end table
2219
2220 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2221 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2222 is running.
2223
2224 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2225 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2226 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2227 outside the debugger.
2228
2229 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2230 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2231 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2232 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2233 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2234 breakpoint settings).
2235
2236 @node Threads
2237 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2238
2239 @cindex threads of execution
2240 @cindex multiple threads
2241 @cindex switching threads
2242 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2243 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2244 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2245 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2246 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2247 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2248 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2249
2250 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2251 programs:
2252
2253 @itemize @bullet
2254 @item automatic notification of new threads
2255 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2256 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2257 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2258 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2259 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2260 @end itemize
2261
2262 @quotation
2263 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2264 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2265 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2266 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2267 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2268 like this:
2269
2270 @smallexample
2271 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2272 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2273 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2274 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2275 @end smallexample
2276 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2277 @c doesn't support threads"?
2278 @end quotation
2279
2280 @cindex focus of debugging
2281 @cindex current thread
2282 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2283 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2284 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2285 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2286 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2287
2288 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2289 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2290 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2291 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2292 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2293 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2294 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2295 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2296 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2297 LynxOS, you might see
2298
2299 @smallexample
2300 [New process 35 thread 27]
2301 @end smallexample
2302
2303 @noindent
2304 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2305 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2306 further qualifier.
2307
2308 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2309 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2310 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2311 @c program?
2312 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2313 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2314 @c threads ab initio?
2315
2316 @cindex thread number
2317 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2318 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2319 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2320
2321 @table @code
2322 @kindex info threads
2323 @item info threads
2324 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2325 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2326
2327 @enumerate
2328 @item
2329 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2330
2331 @item
2332 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2333
2334 @item
2335 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2336 @end enumerate
2337
2338 @noindent
2339 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2340 indicates the current thread.
2341
2342 For example,
2343 @end table
2344 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2345
2346 @smallexample
2347 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2348 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2349 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2350 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2351 at threadtest.c:68
2352 @end smallexample
2353
2354 On HP-UX systems:
2355
2356 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2357 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2358 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2359 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2360 thread in your program.
2361
2362 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2363 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2364 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2365 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2366 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2367 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2368 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2369 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2370 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2371 HP-UX, you see
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2379
2380 @table @code
2381 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2382 @item info threads
2383 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2384 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2385
2386 @enumerate
2387 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2388
2389 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2390
2391 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2392 @end enumerate
2393
2394 @noindent
2395 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2396 indicates the current thread.
2397
2398 For example,
2399 @end table
2400 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2401
2402 @smallexample
2403 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2404 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2405 at quicksort.c:137
2406 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2407 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2408 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2409 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2410 @end smallexample
2411
2412 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2413 Solaris-specific command:
2414
2415 @table @code
2416 @item maint info sol-threads
2417 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2418 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2419 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2420 @end table
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2424 @item thread @var{threadno}
2425 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2426 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2427 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2428 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2429 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2433 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2434 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2435 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2436 @end smallexample
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2440 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2441 threads.
2442
2443 @kindex thread apply
2444 @cindex apply command to several threads
2445 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2446 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2447 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2448 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2449 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2450 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2451 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2452 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2453 @end table
2454
2455 @cindex automatic thread selection
2456 @cindex switching threads automatically
2457 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2458 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2459 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2460 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2461 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2462 thread.
2463
2464 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2465 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2466 programs with multiple threads.
2467
2468 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2469 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2470
2471 @node Processes
2472 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2473
2474 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2475 @cindex multiple processes
2476 @cindex processes, multiple
2477 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2478 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2479 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2480 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2481 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2482 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2483 will cause it to terminate.
2484
2485 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2486 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2487 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2488 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2489 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2490 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2491 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2492 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2493 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2494 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2495
2496 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2497 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2498 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2499 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2500
2501 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2502 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2503
2504 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2505 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2506
2507 @table @code
2508 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2509 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2510 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2511 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2512 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2513
2514 @table @code
2515 @item parent
2516 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2517 unimpeded. This is the default.
2518
2519 @item child
2520 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2521 unimpeded.
2522
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2526 @item show follow-fork-mode
2527 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2531 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2532 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2533
2534 @table @code
2535 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2536 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2537 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2538 retain debugger control over them both.
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @item on
2542 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2543 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2544 independently. This is the default.
2545
2546 @item off
2547 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2548 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2549 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2550 is held suspended.
2551
2552 @end table
2553
2554 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2555 @item show detach-on-follow
2556 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2557 @end table
2558
2559 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2560 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2561 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2562 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2563 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2564
2565 @table @code
2566 @kindex info forks
2567 @item info forks
2568 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2569 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2570 position (program counter) of the process.
2571
2572
2573 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2574 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2575 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2576 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2577 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2578
2579 @end table
2580
2581 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2582 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2583 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2584 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2585
2586 @table @code
2587 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2588 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2589 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2590 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2591 allowed to run independently.
2592
2593 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2594 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2595 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2596 and remove it from the fork list.
2597
2598 @end table
2599
2600 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2601 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2602 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2603 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2604 the child process's @code{main}.
2605
2606 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2607 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2608
2609 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2610 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2611 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2612 argument.
2613
2614 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2615 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2616 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2617
2618 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2619 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2620
2621 @cindex checkpoint
2622 @cindex restart
2623 @cindex bookmark
2624 @cindex snapshot of a process
2625 @cindex rewind program state
2626
2627 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2628 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2629 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2630 later.
2631
2632 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2633 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2634 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2635 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2636 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2637
2638 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2639 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2640 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2641 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2642 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2643 start again from there.
2644
2645 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2646 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2647
2648 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2649
2650 @table @code
2651 @kindex checkpoint
2652 @item checkpoint
2653 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2654 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2655 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2656
2657 @kindex info checkpoints
2658 @item info checkpoints
2659 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2660 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2661 listed:
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @item Checkpoint ID
2665 @item Process ID
2666 @item Code Address
2667 @item Source line, or label
2668 @end table
2669
2670 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2671 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2672 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2673 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2674 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2675 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2676 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2677
2678 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2679 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2680 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2681 the debugger.
2682
2683 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2684 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2685 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2686
2687 @end table
2688
2689 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2690 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2691 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2692 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2693 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2694 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2695 previously read data can be read again.
2696
2697 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2698 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2699 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2700 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2701 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2702 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2703
2704 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2705 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2706 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2707 different execution path this time.
2708
2709 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2710 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2711 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2712 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2713 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2714 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2715 potentially pose a problem.
2716
2717 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2718
2719 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2720 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2721 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2722 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2723 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2724 next.
2725
2726 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2727 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2728 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2729 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2730 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2731
2732 @node Stopping
2733 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2734
2735 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2736 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2737 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2738
2739 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2740 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2741 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2742 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2743 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2744 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2745 explicitly request this information at any time.
2746
2747 @table @code
2748 @kindex info program
2749 @item info program
2750 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2751 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2752 @end table
2753
2754 @menu
2755 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2756 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2757 * Signals:: Signals
2758 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2759 @end menu
2760
2761 @node Breakpoints
2762 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2763
2764 @cindex breakpoints
2765 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2766 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2767 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2768 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2769 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2770 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2771 program.
2772
2773 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2774 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2775 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2776 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2777 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2778 call).
2779
2780 @cindex watchpoints
2781 @cindex data breakpoints
2782 @cindex memory tracing
2783 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2784 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2785 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2786 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2787 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2788 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2789 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2790 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting watchpoints}), but aside
2791 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2792 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2793 same commands.
2794
2795 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2796 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2797 Automatic display}.
2798
2799 @cindex catchpoints
2800 @cindex breakpoint on events
2801 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2802 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2803 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2804 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2805 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2806 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2807 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2810 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2811 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2812 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2813 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2814 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2815 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2816 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2817 enable it again.
2818
2819 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2820 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2821 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2822 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2823 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2824 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2825 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2826
2827 @menu
2828 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2829 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2830 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2831 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2832 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2833 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2834 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2835 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2836 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2837 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2838 @end menu
2839
2840 @node Set Breaks
2841 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2842
2843 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2844 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2845 @c
2846 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2847
2848 @kindex break
2849 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2850 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2851 @cindex latest breakpoint
2852 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2853 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2854 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2855 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2856 convenience variables.
2857
2858 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2859
2860 @table @code
2861 @item break @var{function}
2862 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2863 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2864 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2865 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2866
2867 @item break +@var{offset}
2868 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2869 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2870 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2871 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2872
2873 @item break @var{linenum}
2874 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2875 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2876 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2877 code on that line.
2878
2879 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2880 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2881
2882 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2883 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2884 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2885 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2886 functions.
2887
2888 @item break *@var{address}
2889 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2890 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2891 information or source files.
2892
2893 @item break
2894 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2895 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2896 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2897 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2898 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2899 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2900 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2901 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2902 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2903 inside loops.
2904
2905 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2906 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2907 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2908 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2909 existed when your program stopped.
2910
2911 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2912 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2913 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2914 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2915 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2916 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2917 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2918
2919 @kindex tbreak
2920 @item tbreak @var{args}
2921 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2922 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2923 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2924 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2925
2926 @kindex hbreak
2927 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2928 @item hbreak @var{args}
2929 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2930 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2931 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2932 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2933 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2934 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2935 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2936 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2937 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2938 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2939 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2940 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2941 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2942 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2943 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2944 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2945 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2946
2947
2948 @kindex thbreak
2949 @item thbreak @var{args}
2950 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2951 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2952 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2953 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2954 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2955 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2956 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2957 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2958
2959 @kindex rbreak
2960 @cindex regular expression
2961 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2962 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2963 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2964 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2965 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2966 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2967 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2968 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2969 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2970
2971 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2972 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2973 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2974 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2975 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2976 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2977
2978 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2979 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2980 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2981 classes.
2982
2983 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2984 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2985 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2986
2987 @smallexample
2988 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2989 @end smallexample
2990
2991 @kindex info breakpoints
2992 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2993 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2994 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2995 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2996 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2997 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2998 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2999 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3000
3001 @table @emph
3002 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3003 @item Type
3004 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3005 @item Disposition
3006 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3007 @item Enabled or Disabled
3008 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3009 that are not enabled.
3010 @item Address
3011 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3012 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3013 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3014 @item What
3015 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3016 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3017 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3018 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3019 @end table
3020
3021 @noindent
3022 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3023 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3024 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3025 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3026 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3027 valid location.
3028
3029 @noindent
3030 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3031 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3032 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3033 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3034 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3035
3036 @noindent
3037 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3038 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3039 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3040 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3041 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3042 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3043 @end table
3044
3045 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3046 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3047 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3048 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3049
3050 @cindex pending breakpoints
3051 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3052 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3053 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3054 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3055 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3056 gets loaded.
3057
3058 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3059 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3060 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3061 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3062 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3063 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3064
3065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3066 breakpoint support:
3067
3068 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3069 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3070 @table @code
3071 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3072 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3073 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3074
3075 @item set breakpoint pending on
3076 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3077 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3078
3079 @item set breakpoint pending off
3080 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3081 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3082 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3083
3084 @item show breakpoint pending
3085 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3086 @end table
3087
3088 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3089 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3090 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3091 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3092 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3093 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3094 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3095 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3096 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3097 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3098 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3099 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3100 of these loads could resolve the location.
3101
3102 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3103 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3104 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3105 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3106 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3107 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3108 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3109 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3110
3111
3112 @node Set Watchpoints
3113 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3114
3115 @cindex setting watchpoints
3116 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3117 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3118 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3119 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3120 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3121
3122 @itemize @bullet
3123 @item
3124 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3125
3126 @item
3127 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3128 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3129 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3130
3131 @item
3132 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3133 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3134 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3135 @end itemize
3136
3137 @cindex software watchpoints
3138 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3139 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3140 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3141 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3142 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3143 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3144 culprit.)
3145
3146 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3147 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3148 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @kindex watch
3152 @item watch @var{expr}
3153 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3154 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3155 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3156 to watch the value of a single variable:
3157
3158 @smallexample
3159 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 @kindex rwatch
3163 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3164 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3165 by the program.
3166
3167 @kindex awatch
3168 @item awatch @var{expr}
3169 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3170 or written into by the program.
3171
3172 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3173 @item info watchpoints
3174 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3175 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3176 @end table
3177
3178 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3179 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3180 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3181 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3182 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3183 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3184
3185 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3186 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3187 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3188 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3189 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3190 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3191 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3192 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3193
3194 @table @code
3195 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3196 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3197 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3198
3199 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3200 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3201 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3202 @end table
3203
3204 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3205 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3206 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3207
3208 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3209
3210 @smallexample
3211 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3212 @end smallexample
3213
3214 @noindent
3215 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3216
3217 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3218 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3219 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3220 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3221 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3222 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3223 will print a message like this:
3224
3225 @smallexample
3226 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3227 @end smallexample
3228
3229 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3230 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3231 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3232 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3233 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3234 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3235 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3236 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3237
3238 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3239 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3240 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3241 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3242 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3243 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3244
3245 @smallexample
3246 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3247 @end smallexample
3248
3249 @noindent
3250 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3251
3252 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3253 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3254 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3255 expression with separately allocated resources.
3256
3257 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3258 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3259 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3260 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3261 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3262 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3263 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3264 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3265 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3266 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3267
3268 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3269 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3270 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3271
3272 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3273 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3274 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3275 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3276 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3277 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3278 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3279 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3280 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3281
3282 @quotation
3283 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3284 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3285 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3286 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3287 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3288 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3289 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3290 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3291 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3292 the expression.
3293
3294 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3295 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3296 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3297 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3298 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3299 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3300 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3301 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3302 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3303 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3304 @end quotation
3305
3306 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3307
3308 @node Set Catchpoints
3309 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3310 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3311 @cindex exception handlers
3312 @cindex event handling
3313
3314 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3315 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3316 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @kindex catch
3320 @item catch @var{event}
3321 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3322 @table @code
3323 @item throw
3324 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3325 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3326
3327 @item catch
3328 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3329
3330 @item exec
3331 @cindex break on fork/exec
3332 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3333
3334 @item fork
3335 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3336
3337 @item vfork
3338 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3339
3340 @item load
3341 @itemx load @var{libname}
3342 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3343 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3344 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3345
3346 @item unload
3347 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3348 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3349 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3350 @end table
3351
3352 @item tcatch @var{event}
3353 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3354 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3355
3356 @end table
3357
3358 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3359
3360 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3361 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3362
3363 @itemize @bullet
3364 @item
3365 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3366 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3367 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3368 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3369 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3370 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3371 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3372 disabled within interactive calls.
3373
3374 @item
3375 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3376
3377 @item
3378 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3379 @end itemize
3380
3381 @cindex raise exceptions
3382 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3383 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3384 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3385 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3386 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3387 out where the exception was raised.
3388
3389 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3390 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3391 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3392 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3393
3394 @smallexample
3395 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3396 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3397 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3398 @end smallexample
3399
3400 @noindent
3401 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3402 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3403 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3404
3405 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3406 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3407 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3408 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3409 raised.
3410
3411
3412 @node Delete Breaks
3413 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3414
3415 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3416 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3417 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3418 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3419 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3420 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3421
3422 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3423 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3424 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3425 their breakpoint numbers.
3426
3427 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3428 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3429 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3430
3431 @table @code
3432 @kindex clear
3433 @item clear
3434 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3435 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3436 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3437 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3438
3439 @item clear @var{function}
3440 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3441 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3442
3443 @item clear @var{linenum}
3444 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3445 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3446 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3447
3448 @cindex delete breakpoints
3449 @kindex delete
3450 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3451 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3452 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3453 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3454 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3455 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3456 @end table
3457
3458 @node Disabling
3459 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3460
3461 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3462 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3463 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3464 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3465 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3466
3467 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3468 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3469 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3470 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3471 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3472
3473 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3474 states of enablement:
3475
3476 @itemize @bullet
3477 @item
3478 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3479 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3480 @item
3481 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3482 @item
3483 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3484 disabled.
3485 @item
3486 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3487 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3488 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3489 @end itemize
3490
3491 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3492 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3493
3494 @table @code
3495 @kindex disable
3496 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3497 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3498 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3499 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3500 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3501 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3502 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3503
3504 @kindex enable
3505 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3506 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3507 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3508
3509 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3510 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3511 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3512
3513 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3514 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3515 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3516 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3517 @end table
3518
3519 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3520 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3521 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3522 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3523 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3524 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3525 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3526 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3527 stepping}.)
3528
3529 @node Conditions
3530 @subsection Break conditions
3531 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3532 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3533
3534 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3535 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3536 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3537 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3538 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3539 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3540 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3541 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3542
3543 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3544 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3545 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3546 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3547 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3548
3549 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3550 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3551 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3552 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3553 one.
3554
3555 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3556 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3557 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3558 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3559 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3560 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3561 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3562 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3563 conditions for the
3564 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3565 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3566
3567 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3568 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3569 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3570 with the @code{condition} command.
3571
3572 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3573 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3574 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3575 catchpoint.
3576
3577 @table @code
3578 @kindex condition
3579 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3580 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3581 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3582 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3583 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3584 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3585 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3586 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3587 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3588 prints an error message:
3589
3590 @smallexample
3591 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3592 @end smallexample
3593
3594 @noindent
3595 @value{GDBN} does
3596 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3597 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3598 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3599
3600 @item condition @var{bnum}
3601 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3602 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3603 @end table
3604
3605 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3606 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3607 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3608 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3609 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3610 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3611 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3612 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3613 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3614 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3615 your program reaches it.
3616
3617 @table @code
3618 @kindex ignore
3619 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3620 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3621 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3622 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3623 takes no action.
3624
3625 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3626 a count of zero.
3627
3628 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3629 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3630 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3631 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3632
3633 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3634 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3635 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3636
3637 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3638 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3639 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3640 variables}.
3641 @end table
3642
3643 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3644
3645
3646 @node Break Commands
3647 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3648
3649 @cindex breakpoint commands
3650 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3651 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3652 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3653 enable other breakpoints.
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex commands
3657 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3658 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3659 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3660 @itemx end
3661 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3662 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3663 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3664
3665 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3666 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3667
3668 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3669 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3670 recently encountered).
3671 @end table
3672
3673 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3674 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3675
3676 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3677 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3678 that resumes execution.
3679
3680 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3681 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3682 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3683 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3684 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3685
3686 @kindex silent
3687 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3688 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3689 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3690 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3691 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3692 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3693
3694 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3695 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3696 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3697
3698 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3699 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3700
3701 @smallexample
3702 break foo if x>0
3703 commands
3704 silent
3705 printf "x is %d\n",x
3706 cont
3707 end
3708 @end smallexample
3709
3710 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3711 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3712 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3713 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3714 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3715 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3716 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3717
3718 @smallexample
3719 break 403
3720 commands
3721 silent
3722 set x = y + 4
3723 cont
3724 end
3725 @end smallexample
3726
3727 @node Breakpoint Menus
3728 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3729 @cindex overloading
3730 @cindex symbol overloading
3731
3732 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3733 single function name
3734 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3735 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3736 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3737 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3738 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3739 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3740 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3741 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3742 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3743 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3744 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3745 breakpoints.
3746
3747 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3748 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3749 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3750
3751 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3752 @smallexample
3753 @group
3754 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3755 [0] cancel
3756 [1] all
3757 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3758 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3759 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3760 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3761 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3762 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3763 > 2 4 6
3764 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3765 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3766 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3767 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3768 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3769 breakpoints.
3770 (@value{GDBP})
3771 @end group
3772 @end smallexample
3773
3774 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3775 @node Error in Breakpoints
3776 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3777 @c
3778 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3779 @c
3780 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3781 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3782 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3783 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3784
3785 @smallexample
3786 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3787 The same program may be running in another process.
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3791
3792 @enumerate
3793 @item
3794 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3795
3796 @item
3797 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3798 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3799 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3800 Then start your program again.
3801
3802 @item
3803 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3804 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3805 to nonsharable executables.
3806 @end enumerate
3807 @c @end ifclear
3808
3809 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3810 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3811
3812 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3813 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3814 @smallexample
3815 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3816 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3817 @end smallexample
3818
3819 @noindent
3820 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3821 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3822 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3823
3824 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3825 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3826
3827 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3828 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3829 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3830
3831 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3832 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3833 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3834 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3835
3836 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3837 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3838 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3839 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3840 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3841 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3842 first in the bundle.
3843
3844 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3845 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3846 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3847 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3848 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3849 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3850 is hit.
3851
3852 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3853 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3854
3855 @smallexample
3856 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3857 @end smallexample
3858
3859 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3860 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3861 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3862 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3863 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3864 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3865 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3866 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3869 adjusted breakpoints:
3870
3871 @smallexample
3872 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3873 to 0x00010410.
3874 @end smallexample
3875
3876 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3877 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3878 frequently than expected.
3879
3880 @node Continuing and Stepping
3881 @section Continuing and stepping
3882
3883 @cindex stepping
3884 @cindex continuing
3885 @cindex resuming execution
3886 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3887 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3888 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3889 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3890 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3891 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3892 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3893 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3894
3895 @table @code
3896 @kindex continue
3897 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3898 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3899 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3900 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3901 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3902 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3903 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3904 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3905 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3906 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3907
3908 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3909 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3910 @code{continue} is ignored.
3911
3912 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3913 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3914 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3915 @code{continue}.
3916 @end table
3917
3918 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3919 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3920 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3921 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3922
3923 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3924 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3925 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3926 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3927 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3928 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3929
3930 @table @code
3931 @kindex step
3932 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3933 @item step
3934 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3935 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3936 abbreviated @code{s}.
3937
3938 @quotation
3939 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3940 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3941 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3942 @c distinction here.
3943 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3944 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3945 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3946 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3947 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3948 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3949 below.
3950 @end quotation
3951
3952 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3953 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3954 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3955 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3956 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3957 called within the line.
3958
3959 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3960 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3961 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3962 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3963 was any debugging information about the routine.
3964
3965 @item step @var{count}
3966 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3967 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3968 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3969
3970 @kindex next
3971 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3972 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3973 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3974 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3975 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3976 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3977 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3978 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3979
3980 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3981
3982
3983 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3984 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3985 @c
3986 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3987 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3988 @c function are executed without stopping.
3989
3990 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3991 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3992 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3993
3994 @kindex set step-mode
3995 @item set step-mode
3996 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3997 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3998 @itemx set step-mode on
3999 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4000 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4001 information rather than stepping over it.
4002
4003 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4004 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4005 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4006
4007 @item set step-mode off
4008 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4009 debug information. This is the default.
4010
4011 @item show step-mode
4012 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4013 source line debug information.
4014
4015 @kindex finish
4016 @item finish
4017 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4018 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4019
4020 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4021 ,Returning from a function}).
4022
4023 @kindex until
4024 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4025 @cindex run until specified location
4026 @item until
4027 @itemx u
4028 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4029 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4030 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4031 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4032 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4033 than the address of the jump.
4034
4035 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4036 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4037 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4038 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4039 through the next iteration.
4040
4041 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4042 stack frame.
4043
4044 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4045 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4046 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4047 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4048 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4049
4050 @smallexample
4051 (@value{GDBP}) f
4052 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4053 206 expand_input();
4054 (@value{GDBP}) until
4055 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4056 @end smallexample
4057
4058 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4059 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4060 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4061 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4062 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4063 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4064 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4065
4066 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4067 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4068 argument.
4069
4070 @item until @var{location}
4071 @itemx u @var{location}
4072 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4073 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4074 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4075 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4076 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4077 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4078 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4079 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4080 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4081 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4082 invocations have returned.
4083
4084 @smallexample
4085 94 int factorial (int value)
4086 95 @{
4087 96 if (value > 1) @{
4088 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4089 98 @}
4090 99 return (value);
4091 100 @}
4092 @end smallexample
4093
4094
4095 @kindex advance @var{location}
4096 @itemx advance @var{location}
4097 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4098 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4099 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4100 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4101 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4102 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4103
4104
4105 @kindex stepi
4106 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4107 @item stepi
4108 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4109 @itemx si
4110 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4111
4112 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4113 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4114 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4115 Display,, Automatic display}.
4116
4117 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4118
4119 @need 750
4120 @kindex nexti
4121 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4122 @item nexti
4123 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4124 @itemx ni
4125 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4126 proceed until the function returns.
4127
4128 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4129 @end table
4130
4131 @node Signals
4132 @section Signals
4133 @cindex signals
4134
4135 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4136 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4137 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4138 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4139 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4140 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4141 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4142 requested an alarm).
4143
4144 @cindex fatal signals
4145 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4146 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4147 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4148 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4149 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4150 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4151
4152 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4153 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4154 signal.
4155
4156 @cindex handling signals
4157 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4158 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4159 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4160 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4161 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex info signals
4165 @kindex info handle
4166 @item info signals
4167 @itemx info handle
4168 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4169 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4170 the defined types of signals.
4171
4172 @item info signals @var{sig}
4173 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4174
4175 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4176
4177 @kindex handle
4178 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4179 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4180 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4181 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4182 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4183 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4184 say what change to make.
4185 @end table
4186
4187 @c @group
4188 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4189 Their full names are:
4190
4191 @table @code
4192 @item nostop
4193 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4194 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4195
4196 @item stop
4197 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4198 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4199
4200 @item print
4201 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4202
4203 @item noprint
4204 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4205 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4206
4207 @item pass
4208 @itemx noignore
4209 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4210 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4211 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4212
4213 @item nopass
4214 @itemx ignore
4215 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4216 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4217 @end table
4218 @c @end group
4219
4220 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4221 program until you
4222 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4223 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4224 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4225 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4226 program sees that signal when you continue.
4227
4228 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4229 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4230 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4231 erroneous signals.
4232
4233 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4234 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4235 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4236 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4237 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4238 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4239 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4240 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4241 program a signal}.
4242
4243 @node Thread Stops
4244 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4245
4246 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4247 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4248 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4249
4250 @table @code
4251 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4252 @cindex thread breakpoints
4253 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4254 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4255 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4256 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4257 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4258
4259 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4260 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4261 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4262 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4263 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4264
4265 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4266 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4267 program.
4268
4269 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4270 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4271 breakpoint condition, like this:
4272
4273 @smallexample
4274 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4275 @end smallexample
4276
4277 @end table
4278
4279 @cindex stopped threads
4280 @cindex threads, stopped
4281 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4282 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4283 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4284 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4285 underfoot.
4286
4287 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4288 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4289 @cindex premature return from system calls
4290 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4291 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4292 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4293 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4294 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4295 stop execution.
4296
4297 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4298 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4299 style anyways.
4300
4301 For example, do not write code like this:
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 sleep (10);
4305 @end smallexample
4306
4307 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4308 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4309
4310 Instead, write this:
4311
4312 @smallexample
4313 int unslept = 10;
4314 while (unslept > 0)
4315 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4316 @end smallexample
4317
4318 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4319 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4320 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4321 @value{GDBN}.
4322
4323 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4324 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4325 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4326 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4327
4328 @cindex continuing threads
4329 @cindex threads, continuing
4330 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4331 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4332 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4333
4334 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4335 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4336 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4337 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4338 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4339 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4340 stops.
4341
4342 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4343 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4344 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4345 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4346
4347 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4348 thread to run.
4349
4350 @table @code
4351 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4352 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4353 @cindex lock scheduler
4354 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4355 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4356 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4357 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4358 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4359 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4360 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4361 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4362 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4363 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4364 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4365
4366 @item show scheduler-locking
4367 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4368 @end table
4369
4370
4371 @node Stack
4372 @chapter Examining the Stack
4373
4374 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4375 stopped and how it got there.
4376
4377 @cindex call stack
4378 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4379 is generated.
4380 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4381 the arguments of the call,
4382 and the local variables of the function being called.
4383 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4384 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4385 stack}.
4386
4387 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4388 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4389
4390 @cindex selected frame
4391 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4392 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4393 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4394 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4395 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4396 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4397
4398 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4399 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4400 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4401
4402 @menu
4403 * Frames:: Stack frames
4404 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4405 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4406 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4407
4408 @end menu
4409
4410 @node Frames
4411 @section Stack frames
4412
4413 @cindex frame, definition
4414 @cindex stack frame
4415 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4416 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4417 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4418 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4419 which the function is executing.
4420
4421 @cindex initial frame
4422 @cindex outermost frame
4423 @cindex innermost frame
4424 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4425 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4426 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4427 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4428 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4429 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4430 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4431 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4432
4433 @cindex frame pointer
4434 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4435 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4436 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4437 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4438 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4439 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4440
4441 @cindex frame number
4442 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4443 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4444 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4445 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4446 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4447
4448 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4449 @c underflow problems.
4450 @cindex frameless execution
4451 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4452 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4453 @smallexample
4454 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4455 @end smallexample
4456 generates functions without a frame.)
4457 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4458 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4459 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4460 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4461 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4462 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4463 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4464
4465 @table @code
4466 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4467 @cindex current stack frame
4468 @item frame @var{args}
4469 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4470 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4471 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4472 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4473
4474 @kindex select-frame
4475 @cindex selecting frame silently
4476 @item select-frame
4477 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4478 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4479 @code{frame}.
4480 @end table
4481
4482 @node Backtrace
4483 @section Backtraces
4484
4485 @cindex traceback
4486 @cindex call stack traces
4487 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4488 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4489 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4490 stack.
4491
4492 @table @code
4493 @kindex backtrace
4494 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4495 @item backtrace
4496 @itemx bt
4497 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4498 frames in the stack.
4499
4500 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4501 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4502
4503 @item backtrace @var{n}
4504 @itemx bt @var{n}
4505 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4506
4507 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4508 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4509 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4510
4511 @item backtrace full
4512 @itemx bt full
4513 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4514 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4515 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4516 number of frames to print, as described above.
4517 @end table
4518
4519 @kindex where
4520 @kindex info stack
4521 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4522 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4523
4524 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4525 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4526 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4527 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4528 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4529 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4530 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4531 multi-threaded program.
4532
4533 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4534 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4535 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4536 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4537 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4538 line number.
4539
4540 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4541 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4542
4543 @smallexample
4544 @group
4545 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4546 at builtin.c:993
4547 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4548 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4549 at macro.c:71
4550 (More stack frames follow...)
4551 @end group
4552 @end smallexample
4553
4554 @noindent
4555 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4556 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4557 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4558
4559 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4560 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4561 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4562 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4563 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4564 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4565 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4566 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4567 such a backtrace might look like:
4568
4569 @smallexample
4570 @group
4571 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4572 at builtin.c:993
4573 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4574 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4575 at macro.c:71
4576 (More stack frames follow...)
4577 @end group
4578 @end smallexample
4579
4580 @noindent
4581 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4582 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4583
4584 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4585 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4586 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4587
4588 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4589 @cindex program entry point
4590 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4591 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4592 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4593 @code{main}@footnote{
4594 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4595 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4596 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4597 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4598 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4599 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4600
4601 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4602 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4603
4604 @table @code
4605 @item set backtrace past-main
4606 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4607 @kindex set backtrace
4608 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4609
4610 @item set backtrace past-main off
4611 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4612 default.
4613
4614 @item show backtrace past-main
4615 @kindex show backtrace
4616 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4617
4618 @item set backtrace past-entry
4619 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4620 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4621 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4622 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4623
4624 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4625 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4626 application. This is the default.
4627
4628 @item show backtrace past-entry
4629 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4630
4631 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4632 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4633 @cindex backtrace limit
4634 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4635 unlimited.
4636
4637 @item show backtrace limit
4638 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 @node Selection
4642 @section Selecting a frame
4643
4644 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4645 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4646 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4647 of the stack frame just selected.
4648
4649 @table @code
4650 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4651 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4652 @item frame @var{n}
4653 @itemx f @var{n}
4654 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4655 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4656 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4657 @code{main}.
4658
4659 @item frame @var{addr}
4660 @itemx f @var{addr}
4661 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4662 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4663 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4664 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4665 switches between them.
4666
4667 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4668 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4669
4670 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4671 pointer and a program counter.
4672
4673 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4674 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4675
4676 @kindex up
4677 @item up @var{n}
4678 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4679 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4680 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4681
4682 @kindex down
4683 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4684 @item down @var{n}
4685 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4686 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4687 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4688 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4692 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4693 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4694 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4695
4696 @need 1000
4697 For example:
4698
4699 @smallexample
4700 @group
4701 (@value{GDBP}) up
4702 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4703 at env.c:10
4704 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4705 @end group
4706 @end smallexample
4707
4708 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4709 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4710 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4711 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4712 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4713 for details.
4714
4715 @table @code
4716 @kindex down-silently
4717 @kindex up-silently
4718 @item up-silently @var{n}
4719 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4720 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4721 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4722 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4723 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4724 distracting.
4725 @end table
4726
4727 @node Frame Info
4728 @section Information about a frame
4729
4730 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4731 stack frame.
4732
4733 @table @code
4734 @item frame
4735 @itemx f
4736 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4737 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4738 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4739 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4740 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4741
4742 @kindex info frame
4743 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4744 @item info frame
4745 @itemx info f
4746 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4747 including:
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item
4751 the address of the frame
4752 @item
4753 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4754 @item
4755 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4756 @item
4757 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4758 @item
4759 the address of the frame's arguments
4760 @item
4761 the address of the frame's local variables
4762 @item
4763 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4764 @item
4765 which registers were saved in the frame
4766 @end itemize
4767
4768 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4769 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4770 the usual conventions.
4771
4772 @item info frame @var{addr}
4773 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4774 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4775 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4776 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4777 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4778 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4779
4780 @kindex info args
4781 @item info args
4782 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4783
4784 @item info locals
4785 @kindex info locals
4786 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4787 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4788 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4789
4790 @kindex info catch
4791 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4792 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4793 @item info catch
4794 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4795 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4796 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4797 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4798 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4799
4800 @end table
4801
4802
4803 @node Source
4804 @chapter Examining Source Files
4805
4806 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4807 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4808 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4809 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4810 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4811 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4812 source files by explicit command.
4813
4814 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4815 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4816 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4817
4818 @menu
4819 * List:: Printing source lines
4820 * Edit:: Editing source files
4821 * Search:: Searching source files
4822 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4823 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4824 @end menu
4825
4826 @node List
4827 @section Printing source lines
4828
4829 @kindex list
4830 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4831 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4832 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4833 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4834
4835 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4836
4837 @table @code
4838 @item list @var{linenum}
4839 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4840 current source file.
4841
4842 @item list @var{function}
4843 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4844 @var{function}.
4845
4846 @item list
4847 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4848 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4849 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4850 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4851 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4852
4853 @item list -
4854 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4855 @end table
4856
4857 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4858 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4859 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4860
4861 @table @code
4862 @kindex set listsize
4863 @item set listsize @var{count}
4864 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4865 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4866
4867 @kindex show listsize
4868 @item show listsize
4869 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4870 @end table
4871
4872 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4873 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4874 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4875 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4876 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4877
4878 @cindex linespec
4879 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4880 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4881 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4882 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4883
4884 @table @code
4885 @item list @var{linespec}
4886 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4887
4888 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4889 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4890 linespecs.
4891
4892 @item list ,@var{last}
4893 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4894
4895 @item list @var{first},
4896 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4897
4898 @item list +
4899 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4900
4901 @item list -
4902 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4903
4904 @item list
4905 As described in the preceding table.
4906 @end table
4907
4908 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4909 kinds of linespec.
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @item @var{number}
4913 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4914 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4915 the same source file as the first linespec.
4916
4917 @item +@var{offset}
4918 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4919 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4920 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4921 first linespec.
4922
4923 @item -@var{offset}
4924 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4925
4926 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4927 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4928
4929 @item @var{function}
4930 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4931 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4932
4933 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4934 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4935 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4936 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4937 identically named functions in different source files.
4938
4939 @item *@var{address}
4940 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4941 @var{address} may be any expression.
4942 @end table
4943
4944 @node Edit
4945 @section Editing source files
4946 @cindex editing source files
4947
4948 @kindex edit
4949 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4950 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4951 The editing program of your choice
4952 is invoked with the current line set to
4953 the active line in the program.
4954 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4955 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4956
4957 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4958
4959 @table @code
4960 @item edit
4961 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4962
4963 @item edit @var{number}
4964 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4965
4966 @item edit @var{function}
4967 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4968
4969 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4970 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4971
4972 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4973 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4974 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4975 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4976 identically named functions in different source files.
4977
4978 @item edit *@var{address}
4979 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4980 @var{address} may be any expression.
4981 @end table
4982
4983 @subsection Choosing your editor
4984 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4985 @footnote{
4986 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4987 following command-line syntax:
4988 @smallexample
4989 ex +@var{number} file
4990 @end smallexample
4991 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4992 the file where to start editing.}.
4993 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4994 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4995 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4996 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4997 @smallexample
4998 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4999 export EDITOR
5000 gdb @dots{}
5001 @end smallexample
5002 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5003 @smallexample
5004 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5005 gdb @dots{}
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @node Search
5009 @section Searching source files
5010 @cindex searching source files
5011
5012 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5013 regular expression.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex search
5017 @kindex forward-search
5018 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5019 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5020 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5021 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5022 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5023 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5024 @code{fo}.
5025
5026 @kindex reverse-search
5027 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5028 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5029 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5030 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5031 this command as @code{rev}.
5032 @end table
5033
5034 @node Source Path
5035 @section Specifying source directories
5036
5037 @cindex source path
5038 @cindex directories for source files
5039 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5040 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5041 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5042 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5043 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5044 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5045 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5046
5047 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5048 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5049 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5050 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5051 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5052 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5053 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5054 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5055 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5056 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5057 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5058
5059 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5060 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5061 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5062 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5063 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5064 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5065
5066 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5067 source files.
5068
5069 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5070 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5071 each line is in the file.
5072
5073 @kindex directory
5074 @kindex dir
5075 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5076 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5077 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5078
5079 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5080 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5081
5082 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5083 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5084 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5085 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5086 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5087 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5088 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5089 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5090 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5091 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5092 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5093 name to look up the sources.
5094
5095 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5096 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5097 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5098 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5099 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5100 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5101 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5102 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5103
5104 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5105 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5106 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5107 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5108 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5109 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5110 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5111
5112 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5113 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5114 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5115 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5116 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5117 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5118 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5119 command.
5120
5121 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5122 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5123 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5124 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5125 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5126 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5127 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5131 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5132 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5133 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5134 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5135 part of absolute file names) or
5136 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5137 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5138
5139 @kindex cdir
5140 @kindex cwd
5141 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5142 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5143 @cindex compilation directory
5144 @cindex current directory
5145 @cindex working directory
5146 @cindex directory, current
5147 @cindex directory, compilation
5148 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5149 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5150 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5151 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5152 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5153 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5154
5155 @item directory
5156 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5157
5158 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5159 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5160
5161 @item show directories
5162 @kindex show directories
5163 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5164
5165 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5166 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5167 @kindex set substitute-path
5168 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5169 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5170 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5171
5172 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5173 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5174
5175 @smallexample
5176 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5177 @end smallexample
5178
5179 @noindent
5180 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5181 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5182 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5183
5184 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5185 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5186 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5187 the substitution.
5188
5189 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5190
5191 @smallexample
5192 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5193 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5194 @end smallexample
5195
5196 @noindent
5197 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5198 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5199 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5200 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5201
5202
5203 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5204 @kindex unset substitute-path
5205 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5206 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5207 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5208
5209 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5210
5211 @item show substitute-path [path]
5212 @kindex show substitute-path
5213 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5214 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5215
5216 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5217 rules.
5218
5219 @end table
5220
5221 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5222 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5223 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5224
5225 @enumerate
5226 @item
5227 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5228
5229 @item
5230 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5231 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5232 directories in one command.
5233 @end enumerate
5234
5235 @node Machine Code
5236 @section Source and machine code
5237 @cindex source line and its code address
5238
5239 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5240 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5241 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5242 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5243 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5244 well as hex.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex info line
5248 @item info line @var{linespec}
5249 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5250 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5251 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5252 source lines}).
5253 @end table
5254
5255 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5256 the object code for the first line of function
5257 @code{m4_changequote}:
5258
5259 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5260 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5261 @smallexample
5262 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5263 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5264 @end smallexample
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 @cindex code address and its source line
5268 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5269 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5270 @smallexample
5271 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5272 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5273 @end smallexample
5274
5275 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5276 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5277 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5278 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5279 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5280 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5281 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5282 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5283 variables}).
5284
5285 @table @code
5286 @kindex disassemble
5287 @cindex assembly instructions
5288 @cindex instructions, assembly
5289 @cindex machine instructions
5290 @cindex listing machine instructions
5291 @item disassemble
5292 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5293 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5294 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5295 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5296 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5297 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5298 @end table
5299
5300 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5301 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5302
5303 @smallexample
5304 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5305 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5306 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5307 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5308 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5309 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5310 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5311 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5312 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5313 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5314 End of assembler dump.
5315 @end smallexample
5316
5317 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5318 mnemonics or other syntax.
5319
5320 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5321 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5322 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5323 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5324 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5325
5326 @table @code
5327 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5328 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5329 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5330 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5331 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5332 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5333
5334 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5335 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5336 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5337 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5338
5339 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5340 @item show disassembly-flavor
5341 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5342 @end table
5343
5344
5345 @node Data
5346 @chapter Examining Data
5347
5348 @cindex printing data
5349 @cindex examining data
5350 @kindex print
5351 @kindex inspect
5352 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5353 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5354 @c different window or something like that.
5355 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5356 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5357 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5358 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5359 Different Languages}).
5360
5361 @table @code
5362 @item print @var{expr}
5363 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5364 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5365 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5366 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5367 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5368 formats}.
5369
5370 @item print
5371 @itemx print /@var{f}
5372 @cindex reprint the last value
5373 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5374 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5375 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5376 @end table
5377
5378 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5379 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5380 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5381
5382 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5383 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5384 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5385 Table}.
5386
5387 @menu
5388 * Expressions:: Expressions
5389 * Variables:: Program variables
5390 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5391 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5392 * Memory:: Examining memory
5393 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5394 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5395 * Value History:: Value history
5396 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5397 * Registers:: Registers
5398 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5399 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5400 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5401 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5402 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5403 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5404 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5405 character set than GDB does
5406 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5407 @end menu
5408
5409 @node Expressions
5410 @section Expressions
5411
5412 @cindex expressions
5413 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5414 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5415 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5416 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5417 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5418 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5419 @ref{Compilation}.
5420
5421 @cindex arrays in expressions
5422 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5423 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5424 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5425 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5426
5427 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5428 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5429 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5430 languages.
5431
5432 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5433 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5434
5435 @cindex casts, in expressions
5436 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5437 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5438 at that address in memory.
5439 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5440
5441 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5442 to programming languages:
5443
5444 @table @code
5445 @item @@
5446 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5447 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5448
5449 @item ::
5450 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5451 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5452
5453 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5454 @cindex type casting memory
5455 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5456 @cindex casts, to view memory
5457 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5458 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5459 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5460 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5461 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5462 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5463 @end table
5464
5465 @node Variables
5466 @section Program variables
5467
5468 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5469 in your program.
5470
5471 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5472 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5473
5474 @itemize @bullet
5475 @item
5476 global (or file-static)
5477 @end itemize
5478
5479 @noindent or
5480
5481 @itemize @bullet
5482 @item
5483 visible according to the scope rules of the
5484 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5485 @end itemize
5486
5487 @noindent This means that in the function
5488
5489 @smallexample
5490 foo (a)
5491 int a;
5492 @{
5493 bar (a);
5494 @{
5495 int b = test ();
5496 bar (b);
5497 @}
5498 @}
5499 @end smallexample
5500
5501 @noindent
5502 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5503 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5504 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5505 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5506
5507 @cindex variable name conflict
5508 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5509 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5510 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5511 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5512 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5513 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5514 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5515
5516 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5517 @iftex
5518 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5519 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5520 @end iftex
5521 @smallexample
5522 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5523 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5524 @end smallexample
5525
5526 @noindent
5527 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5528 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5529 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5530 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5531
5532 @smallexample
5533 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5534 @end smallexample
5535
5536 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5537 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5538 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5539 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5540 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5541 @c conflict?? --mew
5542
5543 @cindex wrong values
5544 @cindex variable values, wrong
5545 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5546 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5547 @quotation
5548 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5549 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5550 scope, and just before exit.
5551 @end quotation
5552 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5553 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5554 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5555 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5556 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5557 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5558 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5559 variable definitions may be gone.
5560
5561 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5562 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5563 when compiling.
5564
5565 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5566 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5567 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5568 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5569 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5570 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5571 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5572
5573 @smallexample
5574 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5578 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5579 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5580 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5581 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5582 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5583 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5584 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5585 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5586 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5587
5588 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5589 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5590 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5591 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5592
5593 @node Arrays
5594 @section Artificial arrays
5595
5596 @cindex artificial array
5597 @cindex arrays
5598 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5599 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5600 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5601 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5602 program.
5603
5604 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5605 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5606 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5607 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5608 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5609 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5610 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5611 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5612 example. If a program says
5613
5614 @smallexample
5615 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5616 @end smallexample
5617
5618 @noindent
5619 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5620
5621 @smallexample
5622 p *array@@len
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5626 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5627 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5628 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5629 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5630
5631 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5632 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5633 The value need not be in memory:
5634 @smallexample
5635 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5636 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5637 @end smallexample
5638
5639 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5640 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5641 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5642 @smallexample
5643 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5644 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5645 @end smallexample
5646
5647 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5648 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5649 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5650 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5651 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5652 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5653 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5654 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5655 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5656 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5657
5658 @smallexample
5659 set $i = 0
5660 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5661 @key{RET}
5662 @key{RET}
5663 @dots{}
5664 @end smallexample
5665
5666 @node Output Formats
5667 @section Output formats
5668
5669 @cindex formatted output
5670 @cindex output formats
5671 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5672 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5673 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5674 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5675 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5676
5677 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5678 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5679 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5680 letters supported are:
5681
5682 @table @code
5683 @item x
5684 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5685 hexadecimal.
5686
5687 @item d
5688 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5689
5690 @item u
5691 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5692
5693 @item o
5694 Print as integer in octal.
5695
5696 @item t
5697 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5698 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5699 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5700 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5701
5702 @item a
5703 @cindex unknown address, locating
5704 @cindex locate address
5705 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5706 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5707 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5708
5709 @smallexample
5710 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5711 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5712 @end smallexample
5713
5714 @noindent
5715 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5716 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5717
5718 @item c
5719 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5720 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5721 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5722 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5723
5724 @item f
5725 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5726 using typical floating point syntax.
5727 @end table
5728
5729 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5730
5731 @smallexample
5732 p/x $pc
5733 @end smallexample
5734
5735 @noindent
5736 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5737 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5738
5739 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5740 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5741 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5742
5743 @node Memory
5744 @section Examining memory
5745
5746 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5747 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5748
5749 @cindex examining memory
5750 @table @code
5751 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5752 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5753 @itemx x @var{addr}
5754 @itemx x
5755 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5756 @end table
5757
5758 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5759 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5760 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5761 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5762 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5763
5764 @table @r
5765 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5766 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5767 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5768 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5769 @c 4.1.2.
5770
5771 @item @var{f}, the display format
5772 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5773 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5774 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5775 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5776 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5777 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5778
5779 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5780 The unit size is any of
5781
5782 @table @code
5783 @item b
5784 Bytes.
5785 @item h
5786 Halfwords (two bytes).
5787 @item w
5788 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5789 @item g
5790 Giant words (eight bytes).
5791 @end table
5792
5793 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5794 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5795 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5796
5797 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5798 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5799 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5800 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5801 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5802 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5803 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5804 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5805 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5806 a value from memory).
5807 @end table
5808
5809 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5810 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5811 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5812 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5813 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5814
5815 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5816 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5817 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5818 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5819 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5820
5821 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5822 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5823 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5824 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5825 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5826 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5827
5828 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5829 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5830 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5831 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5832 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5833 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5834 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5835
5836 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5837 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5838 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5839 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5840 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5841 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5842 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5843 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5844 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5845
5846 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5847 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5848 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5849
5850 @cindex remote memory comparison
5851 @cindex verify remote memory image
5852 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5853 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5854 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5855 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5856 situations.
5857
5858 @table @code
5859 @kindex compare-sections
5860 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5861 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5862 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5863 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5864 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5865 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5866 remote request.
5867 @end table
5868
5869 @node Auto Display
5870 @section Automatic display
5871 @cindex automatic display
5872 @cindex display of expressions
5873
5874 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5875 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5876 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5877 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5878 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5879 The automatic display looks like this:
5880
5881 @smallexample
5882 2: foo = 38
5883 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5884 @end smallexample
5885
5886 @noindent
5887 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5888 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5889 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5890 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5891 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5892 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5893 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5894
5895 @table @code
5896 @kindex display
5897 @item display @var{expr}
5898 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5899 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5900
5901 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5902
5903 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5904 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5905 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5906 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5907 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5908
5909 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5910 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5911 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5912 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5913 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5914 @end table
5915
5916 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5917 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5918 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5919
5920 @table @code
5921 @kindex delete display
5922 @kindex undisplay
5923 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5924 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5925 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5926
5927 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5928 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5929
5930 @kindex disable display
5931 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5932 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5933 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5934 enabled again later.
5935
5936 @kindex enable display
5937 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5938 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5939 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5940
5941 @item display
5942 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5943 done when your program stops.
5944
5945 @kindex info display
5946 @item info display
5947 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5948 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5949 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5950 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5951 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5952 @end table
5953
5954 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5955 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5956 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5957 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5958 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5959 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5960 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5961 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5962 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5963 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5964 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5965
5966 @node Print Settings
5967 @section Print settings
5968
5969 @cindex format options
5970 @cindex print settings
5971 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5972 and symbols are printed.
5973
5974 @noindent
5975 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5976
5977 @table @code
5978 @kindex set print
5979 @item set print address
5980 @itemx set print address on
5981 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5982 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5983 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5984 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5985 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5986 @code{set print address on}:
5987
5988 @smallexample
5989 @group
5990 (@value{GDBP}) f
5991 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5992 at input.c:530
5993 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5994 @end group
5995 @end smallexample
5996
5997 @item set print address off
5998 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5999 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6000
6001 @smallexample
6002 @group
6003 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6004 (@value{GDBP}) f
6005 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6006 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6007 @end group
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6011 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6012 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6013 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6014
6015 @kindex show print
6016 @item show print address
6017 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6018 @end table
6019
6020 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6021 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6022 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6023 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6024 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6025 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6026 it prints a symbolic address:
6027
6028 @table @code
6029 @item set print symbol-filename on
6030 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6031 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6032 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6033 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6034
6035 @item set print symbol-filename off
6036 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6037 default.
6038
6039 @item show print symbol-filename
6040 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6041 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6045 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6046 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6047
6048 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6049 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6050
6051 @table @code
6052 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6053 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6054 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6055 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6056 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6057 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6058
6059 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6060 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6061 symbolic address.
6062 @end table
6063
6064 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6065 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6066 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6067 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6068 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6069 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6070 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6071 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6072
6073 @smallexample
6074 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6075 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6076 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6077 @end smallexample
6078
6079 @quotation
6080 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6081 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6082 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6083 @end quotation
6084
6085 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6086
6087 @table @code
6088 @item set print array
6089 @itemx set print array on
6090 @cindex pretty print arrays
6091 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6092 but uses more space. The default is off.
6093
6094 @item set print array off
6095 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6096
6097 @item show print array
6098 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6099 arrays.
6100
6101 @cindex print array indexes
6102 @item set print array-indexes
6103 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6104 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6105 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6106 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6107
6108 @item set print array-indexes off
6109 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6110
6111 @item show print array-indexes
6112 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6113 arrays.
6114
6115 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6116 @cindex number of array elements to print
6117 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6118 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6119 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6120 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6121 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6122 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6123 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6124
6125 @item show print elements
6126 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6127 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6128
6129 @item set print repeats
6130 @cindex repeated array elements
6131 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6132 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6133 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6134 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6135 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6136 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6137 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6138
6139 @item show print repeats
6140 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6141 elements.
6142
6143 @item set print null-stop
6144 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6145 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6146 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6147 contain only short strings.
6148 The default is off.
6149
6150 @item show print null-stop
6151 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6152 @sc{null} character.
6153
6154 @item set print pretty on
6155 @cindex print structures in indented form
6156 @cindex indentation in structure display
6157 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6158 per line, like this:
6159
6160 @smallexample
6161 @group
6162 $1 = @{
6163 next = 0x0,
6164 flags = @{
6165 sweet = 1,
6166 sour = 1
6167 @},
6168 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6169 @}
6170 @end group
6171 @end smallexample
6172
6173 @item set print pretty off
6174 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 @group
6178 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6179 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6180 @end group
6181 @end smallexample
6182
6183 @noindent
6184 This is the default format.
6185
6186 @item show print pretty
6187 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6188
6189 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6190 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6191 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6192 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6193 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6194 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6195 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6196 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6197
6198 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6199 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6200 international character sets, and is the default.
6201
6202 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6203 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6204
6205 @item set print union on
6206 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6207 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6208 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6209
6210 @item set print union off
6211 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6212 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6213 instead.
6214
6215 @item show print union
6216 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6217 structures and other unions.
6218
6219 For example, given the declarations
6220
6221 @smallexample
6222 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6223 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6224 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6225 Bug_forms;
6226
6227 struct thing @{
6228 Species it;
6229 union @{
6230 Tree_forms tree;
6231 Bug_forms bug;
6232 @} form;
6233 @};
6234
6235 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6236 @end smallexample
6237
6238 @noindent
6239 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6240
6241 @smallexample
6242 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6243 @end smallexample
6244
6245 @noindent
6246 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6247
6248 @smallexample
6249 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6250 @end smallexample
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6254 and in Pascal.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @need 1000
6258 @noindent
6259 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6260
6261 @table @code
6262 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6263 @item set print demangle
6264 @itemx set print demangle on
6265 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6266 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6267 linkage. The default is on.
6268
6269 @item show print demangle
6270 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6271
6272 @item set print asm-demangle
6273 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6274 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6275 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6276 The default is off.
6277
6278 @item show print asm-demangle
6279 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6280 or demangled form.
6281
6282 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6283 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6284 @kindex set demangle-style
6285 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6286 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6287 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @item auto
6291 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6292
6293 @item gnu
6294 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6295 This is the default.
6296
6297 @item hp
6298 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6299
6300 @item lucid
6301 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6302
6303 @item arm
6304 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6305 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6306 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6307 require further enhancement to permit that.
6308
6309 @end table
6310 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6311
6312 @item show demangle-style
6313 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6314
6315 @item set print object
6316 @itemx set print object on
6317 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6318 @cindex display derived types
6319 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6320 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6321 the virtual function table.
6322
6323 @item set print object off
6324 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6325 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6326
6327 @item show print object
6328 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6329
6330 @item set print static-members
6331 @itemx set print static-members on
6332 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6333 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6334
6335 @item set print static-members off
6336 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6337
6338 @item show print static-members
6339 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6340
6341 @item set print pascal_static-members
6342 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6343 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6344 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6345 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6346
6347 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6348 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6349
6350 @item show print pascal_static-members
6351 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6352
6353 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6354 @item set print vtbl
6355 @itemx set print vtbl on
6356 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6357 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6358 @cindex VTBL display
6359 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6360 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6361 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6362
6363 @item set print vtbl off
6364 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6365
6366 @item show print vtbl
6367 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6368 @end table
6369
6370 @node Value History
6371 @section Value history
6372
6373 @cindex value history
6374 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6375 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6376 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6377 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6378 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6379 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6380 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6381 symbol table.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{$}
6384 @cindex @code{$$}
6385 @cindex history number
6386 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6387 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6388 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6389 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6390 history number.
6391
6392 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6393 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6394 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6395 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6396 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6397 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6398 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6399
6400 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6401 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6402
6403 @smallexample
6404 p *$
6405 @end smallexample
6406
6407 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6408 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6409
6410 @smallexample
6411 p *$.next
6412 @end smallexample
6413
6414 @noindent
6415 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6416 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6417
6418 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6419 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6420
6421 @smallexample
6422 print x
6423 set x=5
6424 @end smallexample
6425
6426 @noindent
6427 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6428 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6429
6430 @table @code
6431 @kindex show values
6432 @item show values
6433 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6434 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6435 values} does not change the history.
6436
6437 @item show values @var{n}
6438 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6439
6440 @item show values +
6441 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6442 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6443 @end table
6444
6445 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6446 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6447
6448 @node Convenience Vars
6449 @section Convenience variables
6450
6451 @cindex convenience variables
6452 @cindex user-defined variables
6453 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6454 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6455 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6456 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6457 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6458
6459 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6460 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6461 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6462 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6463 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6464
6465 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6466 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6467 For example:
6468
6469 @smallexample
6470 set $foo = *object_ptr
6471 @end smallexample
6472
6473 @noindent
6474 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6475 @code{object_ptr}.
6476
6477 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6478 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6479 value with another assignment at any time.
6480
6481 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6482 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6483 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6484 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6485
6486 @table @code
6487 @kindex show convenience
6488 @cindex show all user variables
6489 @item show convenience
6490 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6491 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6492
6493 @kindex init-if-undefined
6494 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6495 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6496 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6497 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6498 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6499 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6500 override default values used in a command script.
6501
6502 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6503 any side-effects do not occur.
6504 @end table
6505
6506 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6507 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6508 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6509
6510 @smallexample
6511 set $i = 0
6512 print bar[$i++]->contents
6513 @end smallexample
6514
6515 @noindent
6516 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6517
6518 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6519 values likely to be useful.
6520
6521 @table @code
6522 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6523 @item $_
6524 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6525 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6526 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6527 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6528 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6529 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6530 to the type of @code{$__}.
6531
6532 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6533 @item $__
6534 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6535 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6536 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6537
6538 @item $_exitcode
6539 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6540 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6541 the program being debugged terminates.
6542 @end table
6543
6544 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6545 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6546 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6547
6548 @node Registers
6549 @section Registers
6550
6551 @cindex registers
6552 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6553 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6554 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6555 your machine.
6556
6557 @table @code
6558 @kindex info registers
6559 @item info registers
6560 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6561 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6562
6563 @kindex info all-registers
6564 @cindex floating point registers
6565 @item info all-registers
6566 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6567 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6568
6569 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6570 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6571 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6572 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6573 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6574 @end table
6575
6576 @cindex stack pointer register
6577 @cindex program counter register
6578 @cindex process status register
6579 @cindex frame pointer register
6580 @cindex standard registers
6581 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6582 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6583 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6584 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6585 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6586 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6587 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6588 you could print the program counter in hex with
6589
6590 @smallexample
6591 p/x $pc
6592 @end smallexample
6593
6594 @noindent
6595 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6596
6597 @smallexample
6598 x/i $pc
6599 @end smallexample
6600
6601 @noindent
6602 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6603 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6604 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6605 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6606 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6607 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6608 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6609
6610 @smallexample
6611 set $sp += 4
6612 @end smallexample
6613
6614 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6615 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6616 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6617 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6618 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6619 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6620 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6621
6622 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6623 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6624 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6625 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6626 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6627 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6628 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6629
6630 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6631 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6632 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6633 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6634 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6635 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6636 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6637 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6638 prints the data in both formats.
6639
6640 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6641 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6642 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6643 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6644 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6645 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6646 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6647
6648 @smallexample
6649 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6650 $1 = @{
6651 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6652 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6653 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6654 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6655 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6656 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6657 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6658 @}
6659 @end smallexample
6660
6661 @noindent
6662 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6663 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6664 value to a @code{struct} member:
6665
6666 @smallexample
6667 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6668 @end smallexample
6669
6670 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6671 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6672 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6673 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6674 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6675 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6676
6677 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6678 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6679 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6680 frame makes no difference.
6681
6682 @node Floating Point Hardware
6683 @section Floating point hardware
6684 @cindex floating point
6685
6686 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6687 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex info float
6691 @item info float
6692 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6693 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6694 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6695 the ARM and x86 machines.
6696 @end table
6697
6698 @node Vector Unit
6699 @section Vector Unit
6700 @cindex vector unit
6701
6702 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6703 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6704
6705 @table @code
6706 @kindex info vector
6707 @item info vector
6708 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6709 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6710 @end table
6711
6712 @node OS Information
6713 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6714 @cindex OS information
6715
6716 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6717 you debug your program.
6718
6719 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6720 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6721 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6722 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6723 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6724 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6725 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6726 structure.
6727
6728 @table @code
6729 @item info udot
6730 @kindex info udot
6731 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6732 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6733 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6734 the @code{examine} command.
6735 @end table
6736
6737 @cindex auxiliary vector
6738 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6739 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6740 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6741 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6742 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6743 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6744 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6745 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6746 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6747 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6748 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6749 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @kindex info auxv
6753 @item info auxv
6754 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6755 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6756 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6757 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6758 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6759 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6760 an unrecognized tag.
6761 @end table
6762
6763
6764 @node Memory Region Attributes
6765 @section Memory region attributes
6766 @cindex memory region attributes
6767
6768 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6769 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6770 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6771 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6772 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6773 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6774 user can override the fetched regions.
6775
6776 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6777 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6778 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6779 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6780 all memory.
6781
6782 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6783 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6784
6785 @table @code
6786 @kindex mem
6787 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6788 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6789 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6790 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6791 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6792 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6793
6794 @item mem auto
6795 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6796 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6797
6798 @kindex delete mem
6799 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6800 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6801 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6802
6803 @kindex disable mem
6804 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6805 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6806 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6807 It may be enabled again later.
6808
6809 @kindex enable mem
6810 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6811 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6812
6813 @kindex info mem
6814 @item info mem
6815 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6816 for each region:
6817
6818 @table @emph
6819 @item Memory Region Number
6820 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6821 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6822 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6823
6824 @item Lo Address
6825 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6826
6827 @item Hi Address
6828 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6829
6830 @item Attributes
6831 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6832 @end table
6833 @end table
6834
6835
6836 @subsection Attributes
6837
6838 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6839 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6840 write accesses to a memory region.
6841
6842 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6843 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6844 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6845
6846 @table @code
6847 @item ro
6848 Memory is read only.
6849 @item wo
6850 Memory is write only.
6851 @item rw
6852 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6853 @end table
6854
6855 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6856 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6857 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6858 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6859 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6860
6861 @table @code
6862 @item 8
6863 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6864 @item 16
6865 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6866 @item 32
6867 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6868 @item 64
6869 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6873 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6874 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6875 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6876 @c
6877 @c @table @code
6878 @c @item hwbreak
6879 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6880 @c @item swbreak (default)
6881 @c @end table
6882
6883 @subsubsection Data Cache
6884 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6885 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6886 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6887 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6888 registers.
6889
6890 @table @code
6891 @item cache
6892 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6893 @item nocache
6894 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6895 @end table
6896
6897 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6898 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6899 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6900 @c
6901 @c @table @code
6902 @c @item verify
6903 @c @item noverify (default)
6904 @c @end table
6905
6906 @node Dump/Restore Files
6907 @section Copy between memory and a file
6908 @cindex dump/restore files
6909 @cindex append data to a file
6910 @cindex dump data to a file
6911 @cindex restore data from a file
6912
6913 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6914 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6915 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6916 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6917 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6918 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6919 files.
6920
6921 @table @code
6922
6923 @kindex dump
6924 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6925 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6926 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6927 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6928
6929 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6930 @table @code
6931 @item binary
6932 Raw binary form.
6933 @item ihex
6934 Intel hex format.
6935 @item srec
6936 Motorola S-record format.
6937 @item tekhex
6938 Tektronix Hex format.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6942 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6943 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6944 form.
6945
6946 @kindex append
6947 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6948 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6949 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6950 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6951 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6952
6953 @kindex restore
6954 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6955 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6956 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6957 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6958 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6959
6960 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6961 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6962 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6963 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6964 from that location.
6965
6966 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6967 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6968 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6969 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6970
6971 @end table
6972
6973 @node Core File Generation
6974 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6975 @cindex dump core from inferior
6976
6977 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6978 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6979 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6980 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6981 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6982 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6983 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6984
6985 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6986 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6987 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6988
6989 @table @code
6990 @kindex gcore
6991 @kindex generate-core-file
6992 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6993 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6994 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6995 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6996 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6997 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6998
6999 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7000 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7001 @end table
7002
7003 @node Character Sets
7004 @section Character Sets
7005 @cindex character sets
7006 @cindex charset
7007 @cindex translating between character sets
7008 @cindex host character set
7009 @cindex target character set
7010
7011 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7012 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7013 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7014 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7015 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7016 @dfn{target character set}.
7017
7018 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7019 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7020 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7021 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7022 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7023 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7024 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7025 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7026 character and string literals in expressions.
7027
7028 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7029 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7030 target-charset} command, described below.
7031
7032 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7033 support:
7034
7035 @table @code
7036 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7037 @kindex set target-charset
7038 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7039 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7040 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7041 list the target character sets it supports.
7042 @end table
7043
7044 @table @code
7045 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7046 @kindex set host-charset
7047 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7048
7049 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7050 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7051 @code{set host-charset} command.
7052
7053 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7054 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7055 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7056 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7057 list the host character sets it supports.
7058
7059 @item set charset @var{charset}
7060 @kindex set charset
7061 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7062 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7063 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7064 for both host and target.
7065
7066
7067 @item show charset
7068 @kindex show charset
7069 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7070
7071 @itemx show host-charset
7072 @kindex show host-charset
7073 Show the name of the current host charset.
7074
7075 @itemx show target-charset
7076 @kindex show target-charset
7077 Show the name of the current target charset.
7078
7079 @end table
7080
7081 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7082 sets:
7083
7084 @table @code
7085
7086 @item ASCII
7087 @cindex ASCII character set
7088 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7089 character set.
7090
7091 @item ISO-8859-1
7092 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7093 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7094 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7095 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7096 this as its host character set.
7097
7098 @item EBCDIC-US
7099 @itemx IBM1047
7100 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7101 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7102 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7103 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7104 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7105
7106 @end table
7107
7108 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7109 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7110 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7111
7112 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7113 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7114 @file{charset-test.c}:
7115
7116 @smallexample
7117 #include <stdio.h>
7118
7119 char ascii_hello[]
7120 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7121 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7122 char ibm1047_hello[]
7123 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7124 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7125
7126 main ()
7127 @{
7128 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7129 @}
7130 @end smallexample
7131
7132 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7133 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7134 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7135
7136 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7137
7138 @smallexample
7139 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7140 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7141 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7142 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7143 @dots{}
7144 (@value{GDBP})
7145 @end smallexample
7146
7147 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7148 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7149 strings:
7150
7151 @smallexample
7152 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7153 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7154 (@value{GDBP})
7155 @end smallexample
7156
7157 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7158 initial character set:
7159 @smallexample
7160 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7161 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7162 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7163 (@value{GDBP})
7164 @end smallexample
7165
7166 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7167 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7168 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7169 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7170 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7171
7172 @smallexample
7173 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7174 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7175 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7176 $2 = 72 'H'
7177 (@value{GDBP})
7178 @end smallexample
7179
7180 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7181 literals you use in expressions:
7182
7183 @smallexample
7184 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7185 $3 = 43 '+'
7186 (@value{GDBP})
7187 @end smallexample
7188
7189 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7190 character.
7191
7192 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7193 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7194 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7195
7196 @smallexample
7197 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7198 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7199 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7200 $5 = 200 '\310'
7201 (@value{GDBP})
7202 @end smallexample
7203
7204 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7205 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7206
7207 @smallexample
7208 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7209 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7210 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7211 @end smallexample
7212
7213 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7214 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7215 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7216 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7217 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7218
7219 @smallexample
7220 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7221 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7222 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7223 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7224 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7225 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7226 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7227 $7 = 72 '\110'
7228 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7229 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7230 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7231 $9 = 200 'H'
7232 (@value{GDBP})
7233 @end smallexample
7234
7235 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7236 string literals you use in expressions:
7237
7238 @smallexample
7239 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7240 $10 = 78 '+'
7241 (@value{GDBP})
7242 @end smallexample
7243
7244 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7245 character.
7246
7247 @node Caching Remote Data
7248 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7249 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7250
7251 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7252 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7253 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7254 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7255 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7256 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7257 volatile registers are in use.
7258
7259 @table @code
7260 @kindex set remotecache
7261 @item set remotecache on
7262 @itemx set remotecache off
7263 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7264 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7265
7266 @kindex show remotecache
7267 @item show remotecache
7268 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7269
7270 @kindex info dcache
7271 @item info dcache
7272 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7273 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7274 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7275 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7276 the data cache operation.
7277 @end table
7278
7279
7280 @node Macros
7281 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7282
7283 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7284 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7285 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7286 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7287 where it was defined.
7288
7289 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7290 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7291 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7292 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7293
7294 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7295 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7296 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7297 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7298 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7299 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7300 see @ref{List}.
7301
7302 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7303 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7304 variable-arity macros.
7305
7306 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7307 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7308 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7309
7310 @table @code
7311
7312 @kindex macro expand
7313 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7314 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7315 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7316 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7317 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7318 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7319 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7320 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7321 it can be any string of tokens.
7322
7323 @kindex macro exp1
7324 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7325 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7326 @cindex expand macro once
7327 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7328 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7329 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7330 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7331 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7332 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7333 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7334 can be any string of tokens.
7335
7336 @kindex info macro
7337 @cindex macro definition, showing
7338 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7339 @item info macro @var{macro}
7340 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7341 source location where that definition was established.
7342
7343 @kindex macro define
7344 @cindex user-defined macros
7345 @cindex defining macros interactively
7346 @cindex macros, user-defined
7347 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7348 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7349 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7350 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7351 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7352 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7353 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7354 given in @var{arglist}.
7355
7356 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7357 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7358 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7359 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7360 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7361
7362 @kindex macro undef
7363 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7364 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7365 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7366 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7367 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7368 debugged.
7369
7370 @kindex macro list
7371 @item macro list
7372 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7373 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7374 @end table
7375
7376 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7377 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7378 show our source files:
7379
7380 @smallexample
7381 $ cat sample.c
7382 #include <stdio.h>
7383 #include "sample.h"
7384
7385 #define M 42
7386 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7387
7388 main ()
7389 @{
7390 #define N 28
7391 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7392 #undef N
7393 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7394 #define N 1729
7395 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7396 @}
7397 $ cat sample.h
7398 #define Q <
7399 $
7400 @end smallexample
7401
7402 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7403 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7404 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7405 information.
7406
7407 @smallexample
7408 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7409 $
7410 @end smallexample
7411
7412 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7413
7414 @smallexample
7415 $ gdb -nw sample
7416 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7417 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7418 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7419 (@value{GDBP})
7420 @end smallexample
7421
7422 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7423 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7424 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7425
7426 @smallexample
7427 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7428 3
7429 4 #define M 42
7430 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7431 6
7432 7 main ()
7433 8 @{
7434 9 #define N 28
7435 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7436 11 #undef N
7437 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7438 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7439 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7440 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7441 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7442 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7443 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7444 #define Q <
7445 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7446 expands to: (42 + 1)
7447 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7448 expands to: once (M + 1)
7449 (@value{GDBP})
7450 @end smallexample
7451
7452 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7453 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7454 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7455 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7456
7457 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7458 the source line of the current stack frame:
7459
7460 @smallexample
7461 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7462 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7463 (@value{GDBP}) run
7464 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7465
7466 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7467 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7468 (@value{GDBP})
7469 @end smallexample
7470
7471 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7472
7473 @smallexample
7474 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7475 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7476 #define N 28
7477 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7478 expands to: 28 < 42
7479 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7480 $1 = 1
7481 (@value{GDBP})
7482 @end smallexample
7483
7484 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7485 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7486 thereof) in force at each point:
7487
7488 @smallexample
7489 (@value{GDBP}) next
7490 Hello, world!
7491 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7492 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7493 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7494 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7495 (@value{GDBP}) next
7496 We're so creative.
7497 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7498 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7499 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7500 #define N 1729
7501 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7502 expands to: 1729 < 42
7503 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7504 $2 = 0
7505 (@value{GDBP})
7506 @end smallexample
7507
7508
7509 @node Tracepoints
7510 @chapter Tracepoints
7511 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7512 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7513
7514 @cindex tracepoints
7515 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7516 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7517 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7518 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7519 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7520 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7521 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7522
7523 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7524 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7525 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7526 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7527 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7528 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7529 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7530 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7531 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7532 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7533 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7534
7535 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7536 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7537 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7538 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7539 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7540 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7541 Packets}.
7542
7543 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7544
7545 @menu
7546 * Set Tracepoints::
7547 * Analyze Collected Data::
7548 * Tracepoint Variables::
7549 @end menu
7550
7551 @node Set Tracepoints
7552 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7553
7554 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7555 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7556 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7557 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7558 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7559 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7560 work on.
7561
7562 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7563 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7564 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7565 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7566 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7567 tracepoint was hit.
7568
7569 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7570 conditions and actions.
7571
7572 @menu
7573 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7574 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7575 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7576 * Tracepoint Actions::
7577 * Listing Tracepoints::
7578 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7579 @end menu
7580
7581 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7582 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7583
7584 @table @code
7585 @cindex set tracepoint
7586 @kindex trace
7587 @item trace
7588 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7589 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7590 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7591 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7592 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7593 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7594 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7595 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7596 running.
7597
7598 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7599
7600 @smallexample
7601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7602
7603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7604
7605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7606
7607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7608
7609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7610 @end smallexample
7611
7612 @noindent
7613 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7614
7615 @vindex $tpnum
7616 @cindex last tracepoint number
7617 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7618 @cindex tracepoint number
7619 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7620 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7621
7622 @kindex delete tracepoint
7623 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7624 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7625 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7626 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7627
7628 Examples:
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7632
7633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7634 @end smallexample
7635
7636 @noindent
7637 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7638 @end table
7639
7640 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7641 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7642
7643 @table @code
7644 @kindex disable tracepoint
7645 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7646 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7647 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7648 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7649 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7650
7651 @kindex enable tracepoint
7652 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7653 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7654 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7655 run.
7656 @end table
7657
7658 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7659 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7660
7661 @table @code
7662 @kindex passcount
7663 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7664 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7665 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7666 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7667 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7668 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7669 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7670 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7671 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7672 user.
7673
7674 Examples:
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7678 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7679
7680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7681 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7688 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7689 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7690 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7691 @end smallexample
7692 @end table
7693
7694 @node Tracepoint Actions
7695 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7696
7697 @table @code
7698 @kindex actions
7699 @cindex tracepoint actions
7700 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7701 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7702 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7703 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7704 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7705 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7706 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7707 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7708 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7709 @code{while-stepping}.
7710
7711 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7712 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7713 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7714
7715 @smallexample
7716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7717
7718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7719
7720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7721 @end smallexample
7722
7723 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7724 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7725 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7726 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7727 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7728 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7729 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7730 @code{end} command.
7731
7732 @smallexample
7733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7735 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7736 > collect bar,baz
7737 > collect $regs
7738 > while-stepping 12
7739 > collect $fp, $sp
7740 > end
7741 end
7742 @end smallexample
7743
7744 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7745 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7746 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7747 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7748 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7749 special arguments are supported:
7750
7751 @table @code
7752 @item $regs
7753 collect all registers
7754
7755 @item $args
7756 collect all function arguments
7757
7758 @item $locals
7759 collect all local variables.
7760 @end table
7761
7762 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7763 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7764 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7765
7766 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7767 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7768
7769 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7770 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7771 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7772 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7773 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7774 its own @code{end} command):
7775
7776 @smallexample
7777 > while-stepping 12
7778 > collect $regs, myglobal
7779 > end
7780 >
7781 @end smallexample
7782
7783 @noindent
7784 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7785 @code{stepping}.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 @node Listing Tracepoints
7789 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7790
7791 @table @code
7792 @kindex info tracepoints
7793 @kindex info tp
7794 @cindex information about tracepoints
7795 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7796 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7797 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7798 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7799 shown:
7800
7801 @itemize @bullet
7802 @item
7803 its number
7804 @item
7805 whether it is enabled or disabled
7806 @item
7807 its address
7808 @item
7809 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7810 @item
7811 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7812 @item
7813 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7814 @item
7815 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7816 @end itemize
7817
7818 @smallexample
7819 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7820 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7821 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7822 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7823 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7824 (@value{GDBP})
7825 @end smallexample
7826
7827 @noindent
7828 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7829 @end table
7830
7831 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7832 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7833
7834 @table @code
7835 @kindex tstart
7836 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7837 @cindex collected data discarded
7838 @item tstart
7839 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7840 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7841 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7842 experiment.
7843
7844 @kindex tstop
7845 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7846 @item tstop
7847 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7848 stops collecting data.
7849
7850 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7851 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7852 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7853
7854 @kindex tstatus
7855 @cindex status of trace data collection
7856 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7857 @item tstatus
7858 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7859 collection.
7860 @end table
7861
7862 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7863
7864 @smallexample
7865 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7866 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7867 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7868 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7869 > while-stepping 11
7870 > collect $regs
7871 > end
7872 > end
7873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7874 [time passes @dots{}]
7875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878
7879 @node Analyze Collected Data
7880 @section Using the collected data
7881
7882 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7883 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7884 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7885 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7886 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7887 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7888 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7889 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7890 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7891 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7892 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7893 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7894 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7895 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7896 the buffer will fail.
7897
7898 @menu
7899 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7900 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7901 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7902 @end menu
7903
7904 @node tfind
7905 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7906
7907 @kindex tfind
7908 @cindex select trace snapshot
7909 @cindex find trace snapshot
7910 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7911 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7912 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7913 snapshot is selected.
7914
7915 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7916
7917 @table @code
7918 @item tfind start
7919 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7920 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7921
7922 @item tfind none
7923 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7924
7925 @item tfind end
7926 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7927
7928 @item tfind
7929 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7930
7931 @item tfind -
7932 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7933 retracing earlier steps.
7934
7935 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7936 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7937 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7938 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7939 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7940
7941 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7942 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7943 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7944 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7945 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7946
7947 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7948 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7949 addresses.
7950
7951 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7952 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7953 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7954
7955 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7956 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7957 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7958 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7959 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7960 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7961 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7962 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7963 @end table
7964
7965 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7966 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7967 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7968 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7969 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7970 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7971 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7972 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7973 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7974 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7975 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7976 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7977 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7978 tracepoint as the current one.
7979
7980 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7981 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7982 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7983 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7984 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7985
7986 @smallexample
7987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7988 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7989 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7990 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7991 > tfind
7992 > end
7993
7994 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7995 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7996 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7997 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7998 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7999 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8000 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8001 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8002 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8003 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8004 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8005 @end smallexample
8006
8007 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8008 the buffer:
8009
8010 @smallexample
8011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8013 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8014 > tfind line
8015 > end
8016
8017 Frame 0, X = 1
8018 Frame 7, X = 2
8019 Frame 13, X = 255
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @node tdump
8023 @subsection @code{tdump}
8024 @kindex tdump
8025 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8026 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8027
8028 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8029 the current trace snapshot.
8030
8031 @smallexample
8032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8033 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8034 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8035 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8036 > end
8037
8038 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8039
8040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8041 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8042 at gdb_test.c:444
8043 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8044
8045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8046 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8047 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8048 d1 0x18 24
8049 d2 0x80 128
8050 d3 0x33 51
8051 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8052 d5 0x22 34
8053 d6 0xe0 224
8054 d7 0x380035 3670069
8055 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8056 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8057 a2 0x100 256
8058 a3 0x322000 3284992
8059 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8060 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8061 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8062 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8063 ps 0x0 0
8064 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8065 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8066 fpstatus 0x0 0
8067 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8068 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8069 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8070 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8071 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8072 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8073 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8074 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8075 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8076
8077 (@value{GDBP})
8078 @end smallexample
8079
8080 @node save-tracepoints
8081 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8082 @kindex save-tracepoints
8083 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8084
8085 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8086 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8087 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8088 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8089 Files}).
8090
8091 @node Tracepoint Variables
8092 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8093 @cindex tracepoint variables
8094 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8095
8096 @table @code
8097 @vindex $trace_frame
8098 @item (int) $trace_frame
8099 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8100 snapshot is selected.
8101
8102 @vindex $tracepoint
8103 @item (int) $tracepoint
8104 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8105
8106 @vindex $trace_line
8107 @item (int) $trace_line
8108 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8109
8110 @vindex $trace_file
8111 @item (char []) $trace_file
8112 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8113
8114 @vindex $trace_func
8115 @item (char []) $trace_func
8116 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8117 @end table
8118
8119 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8120 use @code{output} instead.
8121
8122 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8123 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8124 data.
8125
8126 @smallexample
8127 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8128
8129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8130 > output $trace_file
8131 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8132 > tfind
8133 > end
8134 @end smallexample
8135
8136 @node Overlays
8137 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8138 @cindex overlays
8139
8140 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8141 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8142 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8143 use overlays.
8144
8145 @menu
8146 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8147 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8148 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8149 mapped by asking the inferior.
8150 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8151 @end menu
8152
8153 @node How Overlays Work
8154 @section How Overlays Work
8155 @cindex mapped overlays
8156 @cindex unmapped overlays
8157 @cindex load address, overlay's
8158 @cindex mapped address
8159 @cindex overlay area
8160
8161 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8162 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8163 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8164 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8165 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8166
8167 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8168 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8169 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8170 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8171 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8172 largest overlay as well.
8173
8174 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8175 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8176 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8177 there.
8178
8179 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8180 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8181 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8182
8183 @smallexample
8184 @group
8185 Data Instruction Larger
8186 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8187 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8188 | | | | | |
8189 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8190 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8191 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8192 | and heap | | | | | |
8193 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8194 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8195 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8196 | | | | | |
8197 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8198 address | | | | | |
8199 | overlay | <-' | | |
8200 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8201 | | <---. | | load address
8202 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8203 | | | |
8204 +-----------+ | |
8205 +-----------+
8206 | |
8207 +-----------+
8208
8209 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8210 @end group
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8214 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8215 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8216 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8217 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8218 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8219 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8220 program and the overlay area.
8221
8222 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8223 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8224 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8225 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8226 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8227 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8228 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8229
8230 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8231 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8232 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8233
8234 @itemize @bullet
8235
8236 @item
8237 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8238 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8239 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8240 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8241
8242 @item
8243 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8244 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8245 your program's performance.
8246
8247 @item
8248 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8249 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8250 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8251 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8252 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8253 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8254 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8255
8256 @item
8257 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8258 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8259 instruction and data spaces.
8260
8261 @end itemize
8262
8263 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8264 improved in many ways:
8265
8266 @itemize @bullet
8267
8268 @item
8269 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8270 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8271 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8272 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8273 area in the usual way.
8274
8275 @item
8276 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8277 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8278
8279 @item
8280 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8281 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8282 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8283 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8284 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8285 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8286 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8287
8288 @end itemize
8289
8290
8291 @node Overlay Commands
8292 @section Overlay Commands
8293
8294 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8295 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8296 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8297 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8298 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8299 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8300
8301 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8302 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item overlay off
8306 @kindex overlay
8307 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8308 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8309 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8310 overlay support is disabled.
8311
8312 @item overlay manual
8313 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8314 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8315 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8316 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8317 commands described below.
8318
8319 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8320 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8321 @cindex map an overlay
8322 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8323 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8324 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8325 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8326 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8327 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8328
8329 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8330 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8331 @cindex unmap an overlay
8332 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8333 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8334 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8335 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8336
8337 @item overlay auto
8338 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8339 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8340 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8341 Overlay Debugging}.
8342
8343 @item overlay load-target
8344 @itemx overlay load
8345 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8346 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8347 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8348 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8349 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8350 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8351
8352 @item overlay list-overlays
8353 @itemx overlay list
8354 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8355 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8356 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8357
8358 @end table
8359
8360 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8361 of the function the address falls in:
8362
8363 @smallexample
8364 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8365 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8366 @end smallexample
8367 @noindent
8368 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8369 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8370 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8371 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8372
8373 @smallexample
8374 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8375 No sections are mapped.
8376 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8377 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8378 @end smallexample
8379 @noindent
8380 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8381 name normally:
8382
8383 @smallexample
8384 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8385 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8386 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8387 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8388 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8389 @end smallexample
8390
8391 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8392 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8393 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8394 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8395 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8396
8397 @itemize @bullet
8398 @item
8399 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8400 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8401 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8402 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8403 @item
8404 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8405 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8406 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8407 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8408 breakpoints properly.
8409 @end itemize
8410
8411
8412 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8413 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8414 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8415
8416 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8417 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8418 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8419 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8420 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8421 current state of the overlays.
8422
8423 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8424 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8425
8426 @table @asis
8427
8428 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8429 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8430
8431 @smallexample
8432 struct
8433 @{
8434 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8435 unsigned long vma;
8436
8437 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8438 unsigned long size;
8439
8440 /* The overlay's load address. */
8441 unsigned long lma;
8442
8443 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8444 zero otherwise. */
8445 unsigned long mapped;
8446 @}
8447 @end smallexample
8448
8449 @item @code{_novlys}:
8450 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8451 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8452
8453 @end table
8454
8455 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8456 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8457 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8458 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8459 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8460 currently mapped.
8461
8462 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8463 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8464 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8465 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8466 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8467 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8468 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8469 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8470 are not being executed.
8471
8472 @node Overlay Sample Program
8473 @section Overlay Sample Program
8474 @cindex overlay example program
8475
8476 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8477 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8478 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8479 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8480 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8481 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8482 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8483
8484 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8485 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8486 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8487 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8488
8489 @table @file
8490 @item overlays.c
8491 The main program file.
8492 @item ovlymgr.c
8493 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8494 @item foo.c
8495 @itemx bar.c
8496 @itemx baz.c
8497 @itemx grbx.c
8498 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8499 @item d10v.ld
8500 @itemx m32r.ld
8501 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8502 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8503 @end table
8504
8505 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8506 cross-compiler like this:
8507
8508 @smallexample
8509 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8510 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8511 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8512 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8513 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8514 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8515 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8516 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8517 @end smallexample
8518
8519 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8520 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8521 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8522
8523
8524 @node Languages
8525 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8526 @cindex languages
8527
8528 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8529 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8530 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8531 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8532 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8533 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8534
8535 @cindex working language
8536 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8537 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8538 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8539 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8540 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8541 language}.
8542
8543 @menu
8544 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8545 * Show:: Displaying the language
8546 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8547 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8548 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8549 @end menu
8550
8551 @node Setting
8552 @section Switching between source languages
8553
8554 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8555 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8556 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8557 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8558 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8559 are printed, etc.
8560
8561 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8562 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8563 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8564 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8565 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8566 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8567 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8568 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8569 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8570 Displaying the language}.
8571
8572 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8573 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8574 another language. In that case, make the
8575 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8576 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8577 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8578
8579 @menu
8580 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8581 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8582 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8583 @end menu
8584
8585 @node Filenames
8586 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8587
8588 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8589 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8590
8591 @table @file
8592 @item .ada
8593 @itemx .ads
8594 @itemx .adb
8595 @itemx .a
8596 Ada source file.
8597
8598 @item .c
8599 C source file
8600
8601 @item .C
8602 @itemx .cc
8603 @itemx .cp
8604 @itemx .cpp
8605 @itemx .cxx
8606 @itemx .c++
8607 C@t{++} source file
8608
8609 @item .m
8610 Objective-C source file
8611
8612 @item .f
8613 @itemx .F
8614 Fortran source file
8615
8616 @item .mod
8617 Modula-2 source file
8618
8619 @item .s
8620 @itemx .S
8621 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8622 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8623 @end table
8624
8625 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8626 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8627
8628 @node Manually
8629 @subsection Setting the working language
8630
8631 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8632 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8633 your program.
8634
8635 @kindex set language
8636 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8637 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8638 a language, such as
8639 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8640 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8641
8642 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8643 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8644 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8645 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8646 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8647 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8648 command such as:
8649
8650 @smallexample
8651 print a = b + c
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 @noindent
8655 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8656 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8657 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8658 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8659
8660 @node Automatically
8661 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8662
8663 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8664 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8665 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8666 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8667 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8668 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8669 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8670 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8671 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8672
8673 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8674 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8675 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8676 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8677 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8678
8679 @node Show
8680 @section Displaying the language
8681
8682 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8683 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8684
8685 @table @code
8686 @item show language
8687 @kindex show language
8688 Display the current working language. This is the
8689 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8690 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8691
8692 @item info frame
8693 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8694 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8695 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8696 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8697 information listed here.
8698
8699 @item info source
8700 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8701 Display the source language of this source file.
8702 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8703 information listed here.
8704 @end table
8705
8706 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8707 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8708 with a language explicitly:
8709
8710 @table @code
8711 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8712 @kindex set extension-language
8713 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8714 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8715
8716 @item info extensions
8717 @kindex info extensions
8718 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8719 @end table
8720
8721 @node Checks
8722 @section Type and range checking
8723
8724 @quotation
8725 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8726 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8727 section documents the intended facilities.
8728 @end quotation
8729 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8730
8731 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8732 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8733 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8734 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8735 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8736 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8737 errors when your program is running.
8738
8739 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8740 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8741 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8742 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8743 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8744 automatically based on your program's source language.
8745 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8746 settings of supported languages.
8747
8748 @menu
8749 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8750 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8751 @end menu
8752
8753 @cindex type checking
8754 @cindex checks, type
8755 @node Type Checking
8756 @subsection An overview of type checking
8757
8758 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8759 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8760 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8761 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8762
8763 @smallexample
8764 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8765 @exdent but
8766 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8767 @end smallexample
8768
8769 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8770 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8771
8772 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8773 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8774 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8775 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8776 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8777 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8778 also issues a warning.
8779
8780 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8781 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8782 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8783 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8784 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8785 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8786
8787 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8788 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8789 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8790 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8791 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8792 details on specific languages.
8793
8794 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8795
8796 @kindex set check type
8797 @kindex show check type
8798 @table @code
8799 @item set check type auto
8800 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8801 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8802 each language.
8803
8804 @item set check type on
8805 @itemx set check type off
8806 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8807 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8808 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8809 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8810 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8811
8812 @item set check type warn
8813 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8814 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8815 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8816 numbers and structures.
8817
8818 @item show type
8819 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8820 is setting it automatically.
8821 @end table
8822
8823 @cindex range checking
8824 @cindex checks, range
8825 @node Range Checking
8826 @subsection An overview of range checking
8827
8828 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8829 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8830 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8831 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8832 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8833
8834 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8835 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8836 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8837 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8838
8839 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8840 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8841 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8842 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8843 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8844 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8845
8846 @smallexample
8847 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8848 @end smallexample
8849
8850 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8851 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8852 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8853
8854 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8855
8856 @kindex set check range
8857 @kindex show check range
8858 @table @code
8859 @item set check range auto
8860 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8861 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8862 each language.
8863
8864 @item set check range on
8865 @itemx set check range off
8866 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8867 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8868 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8869 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8870
8871 @item set check range warn
8872 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8873 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8874 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8875 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8876 systems).
8877
8878 @item show range
8879 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8880 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8881 @end table
8882
8883 @node Supported languages
8884 @section Supported languages
8885
8886 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8887 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8888 @c This is false ...
8889 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8890 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8891 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8892 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8893 language.
8894
8895 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8896 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8897 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8898 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8899 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8900 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8901 language reference or tutorial.
8902
8903 @menu
8904 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8905 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8906 * Fortran:: Fortran
8907 * Pascal:: Pascal
8908 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8909 * Ada:: Ada
8910 @end menu
8911
8912 @node C
8913 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8914
8915 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8916 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8917
8918 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8919 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8920 together.
8921
8922 @cindex C@t{++}
8923 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8924 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8925 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8926 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8927 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8928 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8929 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8930
8931 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8932 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8933 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8934 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8935 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8936 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8937
8938 @menu
8939 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8940 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8941 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8942 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8943 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8944 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8945 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8946 @end menu
8947
8948 @node C Operators
8949 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8950
8951 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8952
8953 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8954 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8955 often defined on groups of types.
8956
8957 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8958
8959 @itemize @bullet
8960
8961 @item
8962 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8963 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8964
8965 @item
8966 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8967 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8968
8969 @item
8970 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8971
8972 @item
8973 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8974
8975 @end itemize
8976
8977 @noindent
8978 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8979 in order of increasing precedence:
8980
8981 @table @code
8982 @item ,
8983 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8984 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8985 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8986
8987 @item =
8988 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8989 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8990
8991 @item @var{op}=
8992 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8993 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8994 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8995 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8996 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8997
8998 @item ?:
8999 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9000 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9001 integral type.
9002
9003 @item ||
9004 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9005
9006 @item &&
9007 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9008
9009 @item |
9010 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9011
9012 @item ^
9013 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9014
9015 @item &
9016 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9017
9018 @item ==@r{, }!=
9019 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9020 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9021
9022 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9023 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9024 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9025 and non-zero for true.
9026
9027 @item <<@r{, }>>
9028 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9029
9030 @item @@
9031 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9032
9033 @item +@r{, }-
9034 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9035 pointer types.
9036
9037 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9038 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9039 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9040 integral types.
9041
9042 @item ++@r{, }--
9043 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9044 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9045 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9046 operation takes place.
9047
9048 @item *
9049 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9050 @code{++}.
9051
9052 @item &
9053 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9054
9055 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9056 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9057 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9058 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9059 stored.
9060
9061 @item -
9062 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9063 precedence as @code{++}.
9064
9065 @item !
9066 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9067 @code{++}.
9068
9069 @item ~
9070 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9071 @code{++}.
9072
9073
9074 @item .@r{, }->
9075 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9076 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9077 pointer based on the stored type information.
9078 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9079
9080 @item .*@r{, }->*
9081 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9082
9083 @item []
9084 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9085 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9086
9087 @item ()
9088 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9089
9090 @item ::
9091 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9092 and @code{class} types.
9093
9094 @item ::
9095 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9096 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9097 above.
9098 @end table
9099
9100 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9101 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9102 predefined meaning.
9103
9104 @menu
9105 * C Constants::
9106 @end menu
9107
9108 @node C Constants
9109 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9110
9111 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9112
9113 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9114 following ways:
9115
9116 @itemize @bullet
9117 @item
9118 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9119 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9120 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9121 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9122 @code{long} value.
9123
9124 @item
9125 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9126 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9127 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9128 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9129 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9130 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9131 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9132 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9133 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9134 constant.
9135
9136 @item
9137 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9138 integral equivalents.
9139
9140 @item
9141 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9142 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9143 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9144 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9145 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9146 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9147 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9148 @samp{\n} for newline.
9149
9150 @item
9151 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9152 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9153 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9154 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9155 characters.
9156
9157 @item
9158 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9159 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9160
9161 @item
9162 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9163 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9164 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9165 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9166 @end itemize
9167
9168 @menu
9169 * C plus plus expressions::
9170 * C Defaults::
9171 * C Checks::
9172
9173 * Debugging C::
9174 @end menu
9175
9176 @node C plus plus expressions
9177 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9178
9179 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9180 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9181
9182 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9183 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9184 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9185 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9186 @quotation
9187 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9188 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9189 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9190 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9191 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9192 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9193 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9194 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9195 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9196 C@t{++} code.
9197 @end quotation
9198
9199 @enumerate
9200
9201 @cindex member functions
9202 @item
9203 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9204
9205 @smallexample
9206 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9207 @end smallexample
9208
9209 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9210 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9211 @item
9212 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9213 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9214 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9215 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9216
9217 @cindex call overloaded functions
9218 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9219 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9220 @item
9221 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9222 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9223 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9224 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9225 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9226 default arguments.
9227
9228 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9229 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9230 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9231 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9232 number of function arguments.
9233
9234 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9235 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9236 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9237
9238 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9239 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9240 @smallexample
9241 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9245 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9246
9247 @cindex reference declarations
9248 @item
9249 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9250 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9251 dereferenced.
9252
9253 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9254 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9255 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9256 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9257 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9258
9259 @item
9260 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9261 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9262 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9263 necessary, for example in an expression like
9264 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9265 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9266 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9267 @end enumerate
9268
9269 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9270 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9271 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9272 invoking user-defined operators.
9273
9274 @node C Defaults
9275 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9276
9277 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9278
9279 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9280 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9281 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9282 selects the working language.
9283
9284 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9285 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9286 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9287 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9288 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9289 for further details.
9290
9291 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9292 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9293 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9294
9295 @node C Checks
9296 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9297
9298 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9299
9300 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9301 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9302 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9303
9304 @itemize @bullet
9305 @item
9306 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9307 enumerated tag.
9308
9309 @item
9310 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9311 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9312
9313 @ignore
9314 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9315 @c FIXME--beers?
9316 @item
9317 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9318 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9319 compilers.)
9320 @end ignore
9321 @end itemize
9322
9323 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9324 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9325 that is not itself an array.
9326
9327 @node Debugging C
9328 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9329
9330 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9331 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9332 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9333 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9334
9335 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9336 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9337 ,Expressions}.
9338
9339 @menu
9340 * Debugging C plus plus::
9341 @end menu
9342
9343 @node Debugging C plus plus
9344 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9345
9346 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9347
9348 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9349 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9350
9351 @table @code
9352 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9353 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9354 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9355 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9356 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9357
9358 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9359 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9360 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9361 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9362 classes.
9363 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9364
9365 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9366 @item catch throw
9367 @itemx catch catch
9368 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9369 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9370
9371 @cindex inheritance
9372 @item ptype @var{typename}
9373 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9374 @var{typename}.
9375 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9376
9377 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9378 @item set print demangle
9379 @itemx show print demangle
9380 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9381 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9382 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9383 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9384 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9385
9386 @item set print object
9387 @itemx show print object
9388 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9389 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9390
9391 @item set print vtbl
9392 @itemx show print vtbl
9393 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9394 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9395 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9396 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9397
9398 @kindex set overload-resolution
9399 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9400 @item set overload-resolution on
9401 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9402 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9403 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9404 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9405 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9406 message.
9407
9408 @item set overload-resolution off
9409 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9410 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9411 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9412 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9413 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9414 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9415 argument types.
9416
9417 @kindex show overload-resolution
9418 @item show overload-resolution
9419 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9420
9421 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9422 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9423 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9424 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9425 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9426 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9427 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9428 @end table
9429
9430 @node Objective-C
9431 @subsection Objective-C
9432
9433 @cindex Objective-C
9434 This section provides information about some commands and command
9435 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9436 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9437 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9438
9439 @menu
9440 * Method Names in Commands::
9441 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9442 @end menu
9443
9444 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9445 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9446
9447 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9448 names as line specifications:
9449
9450 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9451 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9452 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9453 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9454 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9455 @itemize
9456 @item @code{clear}
9457 @item @code{break}
9458 @item @code{info line}
9459 @item @code{jump}
9460 @item @code{list}
9461 @end itemize
9462
9463 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9464
9465 @smallexample
9466 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9467 @end smallexample
9468
9469 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9470 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9471 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9472 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9473 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9474 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9475 debugged, enter:
9476
9477 @smallexample
9478 break -[Fruit create]
9479 @end smallexample
9480
9481 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9482 enter:
9483
9484 @smallexample
9485 list +[NSText initialize]
9486 @end smallexample
9487
9488 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9489 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9490 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9491 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9492
9493 @smallexample
9494 break create
9495 @end smallexample
9496
9497 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9498 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9499 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9500 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9501 none apply.
9502
9503 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9504 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9505
9506 @smallexample
9507 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9508 @end smallexample
9509
9510 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9511 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9512 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9513 @kindex print-object
9514 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9515
9516 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9517
9518 @smallexample
9519 print -[@var{object} hash]
9520 @end smallexample
9521
9522 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9523 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9524 @noindent
9525 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9526 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9527 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9528 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9529 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9530 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9531
9532 @node Fortran
9533 @subsection Fortran
9534 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9535
9536 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9537 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9538
9539 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9540 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9541 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9542 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9543 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9544 underscore.
9545
9546 @menu
9547 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9548 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9549 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9550 @end menu
9551
9552 @node Fortran Operators
9553 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9554
9555 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9556
9557 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9558 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9559 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9560
9561 @table @code
9562 @item **
9563 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9564 of the second one.
9565
9566 @item :
9567 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9568 represent a section of array.
9569 @end table
9570
9571 @node Fortran Defaults
9572 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9573
9574 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9575
9576 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9577 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9578 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9579 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9580
9581 @node Special Fortran commands
9582 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9583
9584 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9585
9586 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9587 such as common block displaying.
9588
9589 @table @code
9590 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9591 @kindex info common
9592 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9593 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9594 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9595 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9596 printed.
9597 @end table
9598
9599 @node Pascal
9600 @subsection Pascal
9601
9602 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9603 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9604 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9605 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9606 syntax.
9607
9608 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9609 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9610 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9611
9612 @node Modula-2
9613 @subsection Modula-2
9614
9615 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9616
9617 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9618 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9619 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9620 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9621 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9622 table.
9623
9624 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9625 @menu
9626 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9627 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9628 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9629 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9630 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9631 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9632 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9633 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9634 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9635 @end menu
9636
9637 @node M2 Operators
9638 @subsubsection Operators
9639 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9640
9641 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9642 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9643 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9644 following definitions hold:
9645
9646 @itemize @bullet
9647
9648 @item
9649 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9650 their subranges.
9651
9652 @item
9653 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9654
9655 @item
9656 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9657
9658 @item
9659 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9660 @var{type}}.
9661
9662 @item
9663 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9664
9665 @item
9666 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9667
9668 @item
9669 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9670 @end itemize
9671
9672 @noindent
9673 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9674 increasing precedence:
9675
9676 @table @code
9677 @item ,
9678 Function argument or array index separator.
9679
9680 @item :=
9681 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9682 @var{value}.
9683
9684 @item <@r{, }>
9685 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9686 types.
9687
9688 @item <=@r{, }>=
9689 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9690 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9691 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9692
9693 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9694 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9695 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9696 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9697 comment character.
9698
9699 @item IN
9700 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9701 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9702
9703 @item OR
9704 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9705
9706 @item AND@r{, }&
9707 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9708
9709 @item @@
9710 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9711
9712 @item +@r{, }-
9713 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9714 and difference on set types.
9715
9716 @item *
9717 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9718 on set types.
9719
9720 @item /
9721 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9722 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9723
9724 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9725 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9726 precedence as @code{*}.
9727
9728 @item -
9729 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9730
9731 @item ^
9732 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9733
9734 @item NOT
9735 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9736 @code{^}.
9737
9738 @item .
9739 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9740 precedence as @code{^}.
9741
9742 @item []
9743 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9744
9745 @item ()
9746 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9747 as @code{^}.
9748
9749 @item ::@r{, }.
9750 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9751 @end table
9752
9753 @quotation
9754 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9755 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9756 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9757 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9758 @end quotation
9759
9760
9761 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9762 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9763 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9764
9765 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9766 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9767
9768 @table @var
9769
9770 @item a
9771 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9772
9773 @item c
9774 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9775
9776 @item i
9777 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9778
9779 @item m
9780 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9781 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9782 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9783
9784 @item n
9785 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9786
9787 @item r
9788 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9789
9790 @item t
9791 represents a type.
9792
9793 @item v
9794 represents a variable.
9795
9796 @item x
9797 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9798 explanation of the function for details.
9799 @end table
9800
9801 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9802
9803 @table @code
9804 @item ABS(@var{n})
9805 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9806
9807 @item CAP(@var{c})
9808 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9809 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9810
9811 @item CHR(@var{i})
9812 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9813
9814 @item DEC(@var{v})
9815 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9816
9817 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9818 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9819 new value.
9820
9821 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9822 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9823 set.
9824
9825 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9826 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9827
9828 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9829 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9830
9831 @item INC(@var{v})
9832 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9833
9834 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9835 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9836 new value.
9837
9838 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9839 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9840 there. Returns the new set.
9841
9842 @item MAX(@var{t})
9843 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9844
9845 @item MIN(@var{t})
9846 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9847
9848 @item ODD(@var{i})
9849 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9850
9851 @item ORD(@var{x})
9852 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9853 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9854 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9855 integral, character and enumerated types.
9856
9857 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9858 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9859
9860 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9861 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9862
9863 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9864 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9865 @end table
9866
9867 @quotation
9868 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9869 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9870 an error.
9871 @end quotation
9872
9873 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9874 @node M2 Constants
9875 @subsubsection Constants
9876
9877 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9878 ways:
9879
9880 @itemize @bullet
9881
9882 @item
9883 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9884 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9885 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9886 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9887
9888 @item
9889 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9890 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9891 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9892 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9893 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9894 digits.
9895
9896 @item
9897 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9898 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9899 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9900 followed by a @samp{C}.
9901
9902 @item
9903 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9904 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9905 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9906 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9907 sequences.
9908
9909 @item
9910 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9911
9912 @item
9913 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9914 @code{FALSE}.
9915
9916 @item
9917 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9918
9919 @item
9920 Set constants are not yet supported.
9921 @end itemize
9922
9923 @node M2 Types
9924 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9925 @cindex Modula-2 types
9926
9927 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9928 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9929 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9930 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9931 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9932 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9933
9934 The first example contains the following section of code:
9935
9936 @smallexample
9937 VAR
9938 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9939 r: [20..40] ;
9940 @end smallexample
9941
9942 @noindent
9943 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9944 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9945
9946 @smallexample
9947 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9948 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9949 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9950 SET OF CHAR
9951 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9952 21
9953 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9954 [20..40]
9955 @end smallexample
9956
9957 @noindent
9958 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
9959
9960 @smallexample
9961 VAR
9962 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
9967
9968 @smallexample
9969 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9970 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
9971 @end smallexample
9972
9973 @noindent
9974 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
9975 expressions using the debugger.
9976
9977 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
9978 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
9979
9980 @smallexample
9981 VAR
9982 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
9983 @end smallexample
9984
9985 @smallexample
9986 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9987 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
9988 @end smallexample
9989
9990 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
9991 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
9992 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
9993 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
9994
9995 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
9996
9997 @smallexample
9998 TYPE
9999 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10000 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10001 VAR
10002 s: t ;
10003 BEGIN
10004 s := blue ;
10005 @end smallexample
10006
10007 @noindent
10008 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10009 and value of a variable.
10010
10011 @smallexample
10012 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10013 $1 = blue
10014 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10015 type = [blue..yellow]
10016 @end smallexample
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10020 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10021 their @code{C} counterparts.
10022
10023 @smallexample
10024 VAR
10025 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10026 BEGIN
10027 s[1] := 1 ;
10028 @end smallexample
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10032 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10033 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10034 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10035 @end smallexample
10036
10037 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10038 pointer types as shown in this example:
10039
10040 @smallexample
10041 VAR
10042 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10043 BEGIN
10044 NEW(s) ;
10045 s^[1] := 1 ;
10046 @end smallexample
10047
10048 @noindent
10049 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10053 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10054 @end smallexample
10055
10056 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10057 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10058 types:
10059
10060 @smallexample
10061 TYPE
10062 foo = RECORD
10063 f1: CARDINAL ;
10064 f2: CHAR ;
10065 f3: myarray ;
10066 END ;
10067
10068 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10069 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10070 VAR
10071 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10076 below.
10077
10078 @smallexample
10079 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10080 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10081 f1 : CARDINAL;
10082 f2 : CHAR;
10083 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10084 END
10085 @end smallexample
10086
10087 @node M2 Defaults
10088 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10089 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10090
10091 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10092 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10093 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10094 selected the working language.
10095
10096 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10097 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10098 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10099 the language automatically}, for further details.
10100
10101 @node Deviations
10102 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10103 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10104
10105 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10106 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10107
10108 @itemize @bullet
10109 @item
10110 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10111 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10112 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10113 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10114 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10115 returned a pointer.)
10116
10117 @item
10118 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10119 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10120 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10121 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10122
10123 @item
10124 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10125 argument.
10126
10127 @item
10128 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10129 @end itemize
10130
10131 @node M2 Checks
10132 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10133 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10134
10135 @quotation
10136 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10137 range checking.
10138 @end quotation
10139 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10140
10141 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10142
10143 @itemize @bullet
10144 @item
10145 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10146 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10147
10148 @item
10149 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10150 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10151 @end itemize
10152
10153 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10154 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10155
10156 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10157 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10158
10159 @node M2 Scope
10160 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10161 @cindex scope
10162 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10163 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10164 @ifinfo
10165 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10166 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10167 @end ifinfo
10168 @iftex
10169 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10170 @end iftex
10171
10172 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10173 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10174 similar syntax:
10175
10176 @smallexample
10177
10178 @var{module} . @var{id}
10179 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10180 @end smallexample
10181
10182 @noindent
10183 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10184 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10185 identifier within your program, except another module.
10186
10187 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10188 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10189 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10190 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10191
10192 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10193 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10194 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10195 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10196 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10197 @var{module}.
10198
10199 @node GDB/M2
10200 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10201
10202 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10203 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10204 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10205 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10206 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10207 analogue in Modula-2.
10208
10209 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10210 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10211 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10212 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10213 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10214 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10215
10216 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10217 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10218 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10219
10220 @node Ada
10221 @subsection Ada
10222 @cindex Ada
10223
10224 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10225 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10226 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10227 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10228 to be difficult.
10229
10230
10231 @cindex expressions in Ada
10232 @menu
10233 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10234 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10235 in @value{GDBN}.
10236 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10237 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10238 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10239 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10240 @end menu
10241
10242 @node Ada Mode Intro
10243 @subsubsection Introduction
10244 @cindex Ada mode, general
10245
10246 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10247 syntax, with some extensions.
10248 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10249
10250 @itemize @bullet
10251 @item
10252 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10253 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10254 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10255 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10256
10257 @item
10258 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10259 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10260
10261 @item
10262 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10263 @end itemize
10264
10265 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10266 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10267 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10268 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10269 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10270
10271 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10272 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10273 was translated from an Ada source file.
10274
10275 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10276 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10277 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10278 middle (to allow based literals).
10279
10280 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10281 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10282 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10283 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10284 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10285 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10286
10287 @node Omissions from Ada
10288 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10289 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10290
10291 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10292
10293 @itemize @bullet
10294 @item
10295 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10296
10297 @itemize @minus
10298 @item
10299 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10300 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10301
10302 @item
10303 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10304
10305 @item
10306 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10307
10308 @item
10309 @t{'Tag}.
10310
10311 @item
10312 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10313 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10314
10315 @item
10316 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10317 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10318
10319 @item
10320 @t{'Address}.
10321 @end itemize
10322
10323 @item
10324 The names in
10325 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10326 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10327 not currently available.
10328
10329 @item
10330 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10331 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10332 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10333 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10334 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10335 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10336 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10337 indeterminate values.
10338
10339 @item
10340 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10341 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10342 are not implemented.
10343
10344 @item
10345 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10346 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10347 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10348 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10349 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10350
10351 @smallexample
10352 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10353 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10354 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10355 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10356 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10357 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10358 @end smallexample
10359
10360 Changing a
10361 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10362 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10363 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10364 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10365 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10366 declared to have a type such as:
10367
10368 @smallexample
10369 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10370 Id : Integer;
10371 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10372 end record;
10373 @end smallexample
10374
10375 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10376 assignments:
10377
10378 @smallexample
10379 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10380 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10384 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10385 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10386 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10387 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10388 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10389 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10390 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10391
10392 @item
10393 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10394
10395 @item
10396 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10397 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10398 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10399 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10400 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10401
10402 @item
10403 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10404
10405 @item
10406 Entry calls are not implemented.
10407
10408 @item
10409 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10410 formats are not supported.
10411
10412 @item
10413 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10414 @end itemize
10415
10416 @node Additions to Ada
10417 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10418 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10419
10420 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10421 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10422
10423 @itemize @bullet
10424 @item
10425 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10426 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10427 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10428 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10429 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10430 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10431 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10432 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10433
10434 @item
10435 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10436 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10437 surround it in single quotes.
10438
10439 @item
10440 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10441 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10442
10443 @item
10444 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10445 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10446 @end itemize
10447
10448 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10449 to Ada:
10450
10451 @itemize @bullet
10452 @item
10453 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10454 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10455
10456 @smallexample
10457 set x := y + 3
10458 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10459 @end smallexample
10460
10461 @item
10462 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10463 the value of its right-hand operand.
10464 This allows, for example,
10465 complex conditional breaks:
10466
10467 @smallexample
10468 break f
10469 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @item
10473 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10474 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10475 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10476 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10477 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10478 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10479 in strings. For example,
10480 @smallexample
10481 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10482 @end smallexample
10483 @noindent
10484 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10485 period.
10486
10487 @item
10488 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10489 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10490 to write
10491
10492 @smallexample
10493 print 'max(x, y)
10494 @end smallexample
10495
10496 @item
10497 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10498 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10499 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10500
10501 @smallexample
10502 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10503 @end smallexample
10504
10505 @noindent
10506 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10507 clause.
10508
10509 @item
10510 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10511 multi-character subsequence of
10512 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10513 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10514 in place of @t{a'length}.
10515
10516 @item
10517 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10518 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10519 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10520 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10521 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10522 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10523 For example,
10524 @smallexample
10525 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10526 @end smallexample
10527
10528 @item
10529 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10530 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10531 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10532 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10533 object.
10534
10535 @end itemize
10536
10537 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10538 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10539
10540 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10541 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10542 before reaching the main procedure.
10543 As defined in the Ada Reference
10544 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10545 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10546 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10547 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10548
10549 @node Ada Glitches
10550 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10551 @cindex Ada, problems
10552
10553 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10554 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10555 @value{GDBN},
10556 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10557 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10558
10559 @itemize @bullet
10560 @item
10561 Currently, the debugger
10562 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10563 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10564 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10565 to get it printed properly.
10566
10567 @item
10568 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10569 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10570
10571 @item
10572 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10573 argument lists are treated as positional).
10574
10575 @item
10576 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10577
10578 @item
10579 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10580 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10581 the host machine.
10582
10583 @item
10584 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10585
10586 @item
10587 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10588 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10589 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10590 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10591 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10592 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10593 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10594 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10595 you can usually resolve the confusion
10596 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10597 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10598 @end itemize
10599
10600 @node Unsupported languages
10601 @section Unsupported languages
10602
10603 @cindex unsupported languages
10604 @cindex minimal language
10605 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10606 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10607 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10608 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10609 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10610 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10611
10612 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10613 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10614 language.
10615
10616 @node Symbols
10617 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10618
10619 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10620 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10621 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10622 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10623 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10624 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10625 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10626
10627 @cindex symbol names
10628 @cindex names of symbols
10629 @cindex quoting names
10630 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10631 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10632 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10633 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10634 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10635 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10636 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10637 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10638
10639 @smallexample
10640 p 'foo.c'::x
10641 @end smallexample
10642
10643 @noindent
10644 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10645
10646 @table @code
10647 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10648 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10649 @kindex set case-sensitive
10650 @item set case-sensitive on
10651 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10652 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10653 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10654 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10655 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10656 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10657 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10658 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10659 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10660 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10661 case-insensitive matches.
10662
10663 @kindex show case-sensitive
10664 @item show case-sensitive
10665 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10666 lookups.
10667
10668 @kindex info address
10669 @cindex address of a symbol
10670 @item info address @var{symbol}
10671 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10672 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10673 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10674 is always stored.
10675
10676 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10677 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10678 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10679
10680 @kindex info symbol
10681 @cindex symbol from address
10682 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10683 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10684 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10685 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10686 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10687
10688 @smallexample
10689 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10690 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10691 @end smallexample
10692
10693 @noindent
10694 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10695 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10696
10697 @kindex whatis
10698 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10699 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10700 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10701 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10702 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10703 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10704 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10705 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10706 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10707 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10708 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10709
10710 @kindex ptype
10711 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10712 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10713 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10714 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10715
10716 For example, for this variable declaration:
10717
10718 @smallexample
10719 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10720 @end smallexample
10721
10722 @noindent
10723 the two commands give this output:
10724
10725 @smallexample
10726 @group
10727 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10728 type = struct complex
10729 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10730 type = struct complex @{
10731 double real;
10732 double imag;
10733 @}
10734 @end group
10735 @end smallexample
10736
10737 @noindent
10738 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10739 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10740
10741 @cindex incomplete type
10742 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10743 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10744 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10745 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10746 given these declarations:
10747
10748 @smallexample
10749 struct foo;
10750 struct foo *fooptr;
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 @noindent
10754 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10755
10756 @smallexample
10757 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10758 $1 = <incomplete type>
10759 @end smallexample
10760
10761 @noindent
10762 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10763 completely specified.
10764
10765 @kindex info types
10766 @item info types @var{regexp}
10767 @itemx info types
10768 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10769 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10770 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10771 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10772 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10773 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10774 name is @code{value}.
10775
10776 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10777 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10778 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10779
10780 @kindex info scope
10781 @cindex local variables
10782 @item info scope @var{location}
10783 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10784 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10785 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10786 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10787
10788 @smallexample
10789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10790 Scope for command_line_handler:
10791 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10792 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10793 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10794 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10795 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10796 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10797 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @noindent
10801 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10802 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10803 collect}.
10804
10805 @kindex info source
10806 @item info source
10807 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10808 the function containing the current point of execution:
10809 @itemize @bullet
10810 @item
10811 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10812 @item
10813 the directory it was compiled in,
10814 @item
10815 its length, in lines,
10816 @item
10817 which programming language it is written in,
10818 @item
10819 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10820 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10821 @item
10822 whether the debugging information includes information about
10823 preprocessor macros.
10824 @end itemize
10825
10826
10827 @kindex info sources
10828 @item info sources
10829 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10830 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10831 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10832
10833 @kindex info functions
10834 @item info functions
10835 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10836
10837 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10838 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10839 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10840 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10841 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10842 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10843 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10844 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10845
10846 @kindex info variables
10847 @item info variables
10848 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10849 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10850
10851 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10852 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10853 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10854 @var{regexp}.
10855
10856 @kindex info classes
10857 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10858 @item info classes
10859 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10860 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10861 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10862 expression.
10863
10864 @kindex info selectors
10865 @item info selectors
10866 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10867 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10868 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10869 expression.
10870
10871 @ignore
10872 This was never implemented.
10873 @kindex info methods
10874 @item info methods
10875 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10876 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10877 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10878 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10879 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10880 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10881 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10882 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10883 @end ignore
10884
10885 @cindex reloading symbols
10886 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10887 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10888 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10889 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10890 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10891
10892 @table @code
10893 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10894 @item set symbol-reloading on
10895 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10896 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10897
10898 @item set symbol-reloading off
10899 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10900 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10901 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10902 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10903 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10904 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10905 name.
10906
10907 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10908 @item show symbol-reloading
10909 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10910 @end table
10911
10912 @cindex opaque data types
10913 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10914 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10915 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10916 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10917 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10918 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10919 another source file. The default is on.
10920
10921 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10922 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10923
10924 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10925 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10926 is printed as follows:
10927 @smallexample
10928 @{<no data fields>@}
10929 @end smallexample
10930
10931 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10932 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10933 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10934
10935 @kindex maint print symbols
10936 @cindex symbol dump
10937 @kindex maint print psymbols
10938 @cindex partial symbol dump
10939 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10940 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10941 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10942 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10943 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10944 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10945 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10946 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10947 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10948 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10949 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10950 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10951 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10952 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10953 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10954 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10955 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10956
10957 @kindex maint info symtabs
10958 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10959 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10960 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10961 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10962 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10963 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10964 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10965
10966 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10967 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10968 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10969 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10970 structure in more detail. For example:
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10974 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10975 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10976 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10977 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10978 readin no
10979 fullname (null)
10980 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10981 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10982 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10983 dependencies (none)
10984 @}
10985 @}
10986 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10987 (@value{GDBP})
10988 @end smallexample
10989 @noindent
10990 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10991 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10992 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10993 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10994 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10998 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10999 line 1574.
11000 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11001 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11002 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11003 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11004 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11005 dirname (null)
11006 fullname (null)
11007 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11008 debugformat DWARF 2
11009 @}
11010 @}
11011 (@value{GDBP})
11012 @end smallexample
11013 @end table
11014
11015
11016 @node Altering
11017 @chapter Altering Execution
11018
11019 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11020 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11021 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11022 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11023 program.
11024
11025 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11026 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11027 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11028
11029 @menu
11030 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11031 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11032 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11033 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11034 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11035 * Patching:: Patching your program
11036 @end menu
11037
11038 @node Assignment
11039 @section Assignment to variables
11040
11041 @cindex assignment
11042 @cindex setting variables
11043 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11044 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11045
11046 @smallexample
11047 print x=4
11048 @end smallexample
11049
11050 @noindent
11051 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11052 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11053 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11054 information on operators in supported languages.
11055
11056 @kindex set variable
11057 @cindex variables, setting
11058 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11059 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11060 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11061 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11062 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11063
11064 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11065 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11066 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11067 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11068 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11069 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11070 command @code{set width}:
11071
11072 @smallexample
11073 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11074 type = double
11075 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11076 $4 = 13
11077 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11078 Invalid syntax in expression.
11079 @end smallexample
11080
11081 @noindent
11082 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11083 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11087 @end smallexample
11088
11089 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11090 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11091 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11092 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11093 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11094 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11095
11096 @smallexample
11097 @group
11098 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11099 type = double
11100 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11101 $1 = 1
11102 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11103 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11104 $2 = 1
11105 (@value{GDBP}) r
11106 The program being debugged has been started already.
11107 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11108 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11109 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11110 Invalid bfd target.
11111 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11112 The current BFD target is "=4".
11113 @end group
11114 @end smallexample
11115
11116 @noindent
11117 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11118 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11119 @code{g}, use
11120
11121 @smallexample
11122 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11123 @end smallexample
11124
11125 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11126 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11127 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11128 same length or shorter.
11129 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11130 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11131
11132 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11133 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11134 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11135 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11136 and representation in memory), and
11137
11138 @smallexample
11139 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 @noindent
11143 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11144
11145 @node Jumping
11146 @section Continuing at a different address
11147
11148 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11149 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11150 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11151
11152 @table @code
11153 @kindex jump
11154 @item jump @var{linespec}
11155 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11156 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11157 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11158 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11159 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11160 breakpoints}.
11161
11162 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11163 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11164 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11165 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11166 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11167 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11168 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11169 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11170 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11171
11172 @item jump *@var{address}
11173 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11174 @end table
11175
11176 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11177 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11178 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11179 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11180 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11181 example,
11182
11183 @smallexample
11184 set $pc = 0x485
11185 @end smallexample
11186
11187 @noindent
11188 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11189 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11190 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11191
11192 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11193 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11194 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11195 detail.
11196
11197 @c @group
11198 @node Signaling
11199 @section Giving your program a signal
11200 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11201
11202 @table @code
11203 @kindex signal
11204 @item signal @var{signal}
11205 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11206 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11207 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11208 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11209
11210 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11211 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11212 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11213 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11214 signal.
11215
11216 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11217 after executing the command.
11218 @end table
11219 @c @end group
11220
11221 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11222 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11223 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11224 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11225 passes the signal directly to your program.
11226
11227
11228 @node Returning
11229 @section Returning from a function
11230
11231 @table @code
11232 @cindex returning from a function
11233 @kindex return
11234 @item return
11235 @itemx return @var{expression}
11236 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11237 command. If you give an
11238 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11239 value.
11240 @end table
11241
11242 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11243 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11244 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11245 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11246
11247 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11248 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11249 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11250 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11251 of functions.
11252
11253 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11254 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11255 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11256 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11257 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11258
11259 @node Calling
11260 @section Calling program functions
11261
11262 @table @code
11263 @cindex calling functions
11264 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11265 @item print @var{expr}
11266 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11267 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11268 debugged.
11269
11270 @kindex call
11271 @item call @var{expr}
11272 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11273 returned values.
11274
11275 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11276 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11277 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11278 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11279 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11280 value history.
11281 @end table
11282
11283 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11284 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11285 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11286 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11287
11288 @table @code
11289 @item set unwindonsignal
11290 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11291 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11292 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11293 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11294 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11295 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11296 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11297 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11298 received.
11299
11300 @item show unwindonsignal
11301 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11302 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11303 @value{GDBN}.
11304 @end table
11305
11306 @cindex weak alias functions
11307 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11308 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11309 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11310 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11311 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11312 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11313 function instead.
11314
11315 @node Patching
11316 @section Patching programs
11317
11318 @cindex patching binaries
11319 @cindex writing into executables
11320 @cindex writing into corefiles
11321
11322 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11323 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11324 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11325 patching your program's binary.
11326
11327 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11328 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11329 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11330 repairs.
11331
11332 @table @code
11333 @kindex set write
11334 @item set write on
11335 @itemx set write off
11336 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11337 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11338 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11339
11340 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11341 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11342 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11343
11344 @item show write
11345 @kindex show write
11346 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11347 as well as reading.
11348 @end table
11349
11350 @node GDB Files
11351 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11352
11353 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11354 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11355 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11356 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11357
11358 @menu
11359 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11360 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11361 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11362 @end menu
11363
11364 @node Files
11365 @section Commands to specify files
11366
11367 @cindex symbol table
11368 @cindex core dump file
11369
11370 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11371 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11372 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11373 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11374
11375 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11376 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11377 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11378 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11379 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11380
11381 @table @code
11382 @cindex executable file
11383 @kindex file
11384 @item file @var{filename}
11385 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11386 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11387 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11388 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11389 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11390 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11391 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11392 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11393
11394 @cindex unlinked object files
11395 @cindex patching object files
11396 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11397 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11398 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11399 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11400 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11401 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11402 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11403 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11404
11405 @item file
11406 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11407 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11408
11409 @kindex exec-file
11410 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11411 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11412 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11413 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11414 discard information on the executable file.
11415
11416 @kindex symbol-file
11417 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11418 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11419 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11420 table and program to run from the same file.
11421
11422 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11423 program's symbol table.
11424
11425 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11426 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11427 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11428 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11429 @value{GDBN}.
11430
11431 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11432 executing it once.
11433
11434 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11435 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11436 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11437 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11438 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11439 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11440 optimized code.
11441
11442 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11443 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11444 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11445 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11446 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11447
11448 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11449 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11450 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11451 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11452 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11453 warnings and messages}.)
11454
11455 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11456 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11457 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11458 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11459 in stabs format.
11460
11461 @kindex readnow
11462 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11463 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11464 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11465 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11466 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11467 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11468 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11469 entire symbol table available.
11470
11471 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11472 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11473 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11474 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11475 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11476 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11477 @c files.
11478
11479 @kindex core-file
11480 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11481 @itemx core
11482 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11483 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11484 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11485 executable file itself for other parts.
11486
11487 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11488 to be used.
11489
11490 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11491 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11492 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11493 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11494 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11495
11496 @kindex add-symbol-file
11497 @cindex dynamic linking
11498 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11499 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11500 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11501 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11502 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11503 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11504 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11505 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11506 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11507 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11508 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11509 @var{address} as an expression.
11510
11511 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11512 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11513 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11514 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11515 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11516
11517 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11518 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11519 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11520 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11521 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11522 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11523 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11524 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11525 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11526
11527 @itemize @bullet
11528 @item
11529 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11530 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11531 @item
11532 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11533 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11534 @item
11535 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11536 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11537 @end itemize
11538
11539 @noindent
11540 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11541 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11542 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11543 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11544 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11545 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11546 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11547 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11548 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11549 way.
11550
11551 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11552
11553 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11554 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11555 @cindex load symbols from memory
11556 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11557 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11558 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11559 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11560 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11561 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11562 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11563 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11564 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11565
11566 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11567 @kindex assf
11568 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11569 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11570 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11571 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11572 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11573 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11574 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11575 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11576 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11577 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11578
11579 @kindex section
11580 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11581 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11582 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11583 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11584 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11585 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11586 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11587 their addresses.
11588
11589 @kindex info files
11590 @kindex info target
11591 @item info files
11592 @itemx info target
11593 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11594 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11595 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11596 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11597 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11598 current ones.
11599
11600 @kindex maint info sections
11601 @item maint info sections
11602 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11603 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11604 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11605 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11606 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11607 may be arbitrarily combined):
11608
11609 @table @code
11610 @item ALLOBJ
11611 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11612 @item @var{sections}
11613 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11614 @item @var{section-flags}
11615 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11616 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11617 @table @code
11618 @item ALLOC
11619 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11620 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11621 @item LOAD
11622 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11623 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11624 @item RELOC
11625 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11626 @item READONLY
11627 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11628 @item CODE
11629 Section contains executable code only.
11630 @item DATA
11631 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11632 @item ROM
11633 Section will reside in ROM.
11634 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11635 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11636 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11637 Section is not empty.
11638 @item NEVER_LOAD
11639 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11640 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11641 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11642 COFF shared library information.
11643 @item IS_COMMON
11644 Section contains common symbols.
11645 @end table
11646 @end table
11647 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11648 @cindex read-only sections
11649 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11650 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11651 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11652 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11653 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11654 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11655 enhancement to debugging performance.
11656
11657 The default is off.
11658
11659 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11660 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11661 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11662 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11663
11664 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11665 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11666 @end table
11667
11668 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11669 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11670 name and remembers it that way.
11671
11672 @cindex shared libraries
11673 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11674 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11675
11676 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11677 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11678 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11679 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11680 debugging a core file).
11681
11682 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11683 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11684
11685 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11686 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11687 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11688
11689 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11690 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11691 particularly large or there are many of them.
11692
11693 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11694 commands:
11695
11696 @table @code
11697 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11698 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11699 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11700 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11701 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11702 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11703 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11704 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11705
11706 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11707 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11708 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11709 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11710 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11711 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11712 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11713 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11714 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11715
11716 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11717 @item show auto-solib-add
11718 Display the current autoloading mode.
11719 @end table
11720
11721 @cindex load shared library
11722 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11723 command:
11724
11725 @table @code
11726 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11727 @kindex info share
11728 @item info share
11729 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11730 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11731
11732 @kindex sharedlibrary
11733 @kindex share
11734 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11735 @itemx share @var{regex}
11736 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11737 Unix regular expression.
11738 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11739 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11740 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11741 loaded.
11742
11743 @item nosharedlibrary
11744 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11745 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11746 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11747 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11748 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11749 discarded.
11750 @end table
11751
11752 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11753 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11754 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11755
11756 @table @code
11757 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11758 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11759 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11760 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11761 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11762 shared library.
11763
11764 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11765 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11766 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11767 library events happen.
11768 @end table
11769
11770 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11771 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11772 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11773 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11774 not.
11775
11776 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11777 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11778 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11779 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11780 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11781
11782 @table @code
11783 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11784 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11785 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11786 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11787 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11788 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11789 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11790 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11791 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11792
11793 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11794 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11795 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11796 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11797
11798 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11799 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11800 Display the current shared library prefix.
11801
11802 @kindex set solib-search-path
11803 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11804 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11805 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11806 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11807 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11808 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11809 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11810 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11811
11812 @kindex show solib-search-path
11813 @item show solib-search-path
11814 Display the current shared library search path.
11815 @end table
11816
11817
11818 @node Separate Debug Files
11819 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11820 @cindex separate debugging information files
11821 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11822 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11823 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11824 @cindex global debugging information directory
11825
11826 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11827 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11828 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11829 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11830 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11831 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11832 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11833
11834 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11835 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11836 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11837 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11838 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11839 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11840 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11841 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11842 places:
11843
11844 @itemize @bullet
11845 @item
11846 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11847 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11848 @item
11849 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11850 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11851 @item
11852 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11853 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11854 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11855 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11856 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11857 @end itemize
11858 @noindent
11859 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11860 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11861 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11862
11863 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11864 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11865 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11866 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11867 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11868 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11869
11870 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11871 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11872
11873 @table @code
11874
11875 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11876 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11877 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11878 information files to @var{directory}.
11879
11880 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11881 @item show debug-file-directory
11882 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11883 information files.
11884
11885 @end table
11886
11887 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11888 @cindex debug links
11889 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11890 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11891
11892 @itemize
11893 @item
11894 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11895 a zero byte,
11896 @item
11897 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11898 boundary within the section, and
11899 @item
11900 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11901 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11902 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11903 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11904 @end itemize
11905
11906 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11907 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11908 described above.
11909
11910 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11911 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11912 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11913 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11914 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11915 in an ordinary executable.
11916
11917 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11918 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11919 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11920 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11921 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11922 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11923 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11924
11925 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11926 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11927 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11928 complete code for a function that computes it:
11929
11930 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11931 @smallexample
11932 unsigned long
11933 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11934 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11935 @{
11936 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11937 @{
11938 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11939 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11940 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11941 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11942 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11943 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11944 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11945 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11946 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11947 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11948 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11949 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11950 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11951 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11952 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11953 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11954 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11955 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11956 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11957 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11958 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11959 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11960 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11961 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11962 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11963 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11964 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11965 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11966 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11967 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11968 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11969 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11970 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11971 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11972 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11973 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11974 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11975 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11976 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11977 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11978 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11979 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11980 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11981 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11982 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11983 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11984 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11985 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11986 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11987 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11988 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11989 0x2d02ef8d
11990 @};
11991 unsigned char *end;
11992
11993 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11994 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11995 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11996 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11997 @}
11998 @end smallexample
11999
12000
12001 @node Symbol Errors
12002 @section Errors reading symbol files
12003
12004 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12005 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12006 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12007 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12008 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12009 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12010 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12011 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12012 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12013 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12014 messages}).
12015
12016 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12017
12018 @table @code
12019 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12020
12021 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12022 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12023 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12024 in its outer scope blocks.
12025
12026 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12027 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12028 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12029 function.
12030
12031 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12032
12033 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12034 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12035 do so.
12036
12037 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12038 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12039 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12040 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12041 messages}.)
12042
12043 @item bad block start address patched
12044
12045 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12046 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12047 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12048
12049 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12050 starting on the previous source line.
12051
12052 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12053
12054 @cindex foo
12055 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12056 larger than the size of the string table.
12057
12058 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12059 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12060 with this name.
12061
12062 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12063
12064 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12065 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12066 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12067
12068 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12069 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12070 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12071 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12072 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12073 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12074
12075 @item stub type has NULL name
12076
12077 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12078
12079 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12080 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12081 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12082 it.
12083
12084 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12085
12086 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12087
12088 @end table
12089
12090 @node Targets
12091 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12092
12093 @cindex debugging target
12094 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12095
12096 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12097 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12098 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12099 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12100 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12101 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12102 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12103 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12104
12105 @cindex target architecture
12106 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12107 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12108 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12109 command.
12110
12111 @table @code
12112 @kindex set architecture
12113 @kindex show architecture
12114 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12115 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12116 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12117 supported architectures.
12118
12119 @item show architecture
12120 Show the current target architecture.
12121
12122 @item set processor
12123 @itemx processor
12124 @kindex set processor
12125 @kindex show processor
12126 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12127 and @code{show architecture}.
12128 @end table
12129
12130 @menu
12131 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12132 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12133 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12134 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12135
12136 @end menu
12137
12138 @node Active Targets
12139 @section Active targets
12140
12141 @cindex stacking targets
12142 @cindex active targets
12143 @cindex multiple targets
12144
12145 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12146 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12147 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12148 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12149 a core file.
12150
12151 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12152 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12153 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12154 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12155 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12156 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12157 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12158 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12159 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12160
12161 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12162 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12163 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12164 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12165 process target is active.
12166
12167 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12168 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12169 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12170 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12171 process}).
12172
12173 @node Target Commands
12174 @section Commands for managing targets
12175
12176 @table @code
12177 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12178 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12179 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12180 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12181 protocol of the target machine.
12182
12183 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12184 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12185 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12186
12187 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12188 after executing the command.
12189
12190 @kindex help target
12191 @item help target
12192 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12193 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12194 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12195
12196 @item help target @var{name}
12197 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12198 select it.
12199
12200 @kindex set gnutarget
12201 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12202 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12203 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12204 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12205 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12206 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12207
12208 @quotation
12209 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12210 you must know the actual BFD name.
12211 @end quotation
12212
12213 @noindent
12214 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12215
12216 @kindex show gnutarget
12217 @item show gnutarget
12218 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12219 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12220 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12221 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12222 @end table
12223
12224 @cindex common targets
12225 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12226 configuration):
12227
12228 @table @code
12229 @kindex target
12230 @item target exec @var{program}
12231 @cindex executable file target
12232 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12233 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12234
12235 @item target core @var{filename}
12236 @cindex core dump file target
12237 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12238 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12239
12240 @item target remote @var{medium}
12241 @cindex remote target
12242 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12243 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12244 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12245
12246 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12247 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12248
12249 @smallexample
12250 target remote /dev/ttya
12251 @end smallexample
12252
12253 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12254 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12255 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12256 clobbered by the download.
12257
12258 @item target sim
12259 @cindex built-in simulator target
12260 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12261 In general,
12262 @smallexample
12263 target sim
12264 load
12265 run
12266 @end smallexample
12267 @noindent
12268 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12269 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12270 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12271 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12272 Processors}.
12273
12274 @end table
12275
12276 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12277
12278 @table @code
12279
12280 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12281 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12282 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12283
12284 @end table
12285
12286 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12287 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12288
12289 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12290 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12291 various aspects of this process.
12292
12293 @table @code
12294
12295 @item set hash
12296 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12297 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12298 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12299 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12300 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12301 monitor.
12302
12303 @item show hash
12304 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12305 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12306
12307 @item set debug monitor
12308 @kindex set debug monitor
12309 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12310 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12311 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12312
12313 @item show debug monitor
12314 @kindex show debug monitor
12315 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12316 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12317 @end table
12318
12319 @table @code
12320
12321 @kindex load @var{filename}
12322 @item load @var{filename}
12323 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12324 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12325 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12326 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12327 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12328 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12329
12330 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12331 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12332 target is @dots{}}''
12333
12334 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12335 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12336 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12337 specifies a fixed address.
12338 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12339
12340 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12341 load programs into flash memory.
12342
12343 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12344 @end table
12345
12346 @node Byte Order
12347 @section Choosing target byte order
12348
12349 @cindex choosing target byte order
12350 @cindex target byte order
12351
12352 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12353 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12354 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12355 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12356 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12357 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12358
12359 @table @code
12360 @kindex set endian
12361 @item set endian big
12362 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12363
12364 @item set endian little
12365 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12366
12367 @item set endian auto
12368 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12369 executable.
12370
12371 @item show endian
12372 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12373
12374 @end table
12375
12376 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12377 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12378 target system.
12379
12380 @node Remote
12381 @section Remote debugging
12382 @cindex remote debugging
12383
12384 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12385 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12386 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12387 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12388 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12389
12390 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12391 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12392 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12393 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12394 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12395 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12396
12397 Other remote targets may be available in your
12398 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12399
12400 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12401 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12402
12403 @table @code
12404 @item remote @var{command}
12405 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12406 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12407 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12408 @end table
12409
12410
12411 @node Remote Debugging
12412 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12413
12414 @menu
12415 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12416 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12417 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12418 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12419 @end menu
12420
12421 @node Connecting
12422 @section Connecting to a remote target
12423
12424 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12425 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12426 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12427 program as the first argument.
12428
12429 @cindex @code{target remote}
12430 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12431 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12432 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12433 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12434 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12435 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12436
12437 @table @code
12438
12439 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12440 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12441 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12442 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12443
12444 @smallexample
12445 target remote /dev/ttyb
12446 @end smallexample
12447
12448 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12449 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12450 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12451 @code{target} command.
12452
12453 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12454 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12455 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12456 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12457 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12458 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12459 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12460 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12461 target.
12462
12463 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12464 @code{manyfarms}:
12465
12466 @smallexample
12467 target remote manyfarms:2828
12468 @end smallexample
12469
12470 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12471 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12472 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12473 port 1234 on your local machine:
12474
12475 @smallexample
12476 target remote :1234
12477 @end smallexample
12478 @noindent
12479
12480 Note that the colon is still required here.
12481
12482 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12483 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12484 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12485 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12486
12487 @smallexample
12488 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12489 @end smallexample
12490
12491 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12492 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12493 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12494 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12495
12496 @item target remote | @var{command}
12497 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12498 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12499 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12500 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12501 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12502 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12503 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12504 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12505
12506 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12507 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12508 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12509
12510 @end table
12511
12512 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12513 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12514 remote program.
12515
12516 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12517 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12518 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12519 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12520 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12521 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12522 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12523
12524 @smallexample
12525 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12526 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12527 @end smallexample
12528
12529 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12530 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12531 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12532 goes back to waiting.
12533
12534 @table @code
12535 @kindex detach (remote)
12536 @item detach
12537 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12538 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12539 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12540 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12541 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12542
12543 @kindex disconnect
12544 @item disconnect
12545 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12546 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12547 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12548 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12549 another target.
12550
12551 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12552 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12553 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12554 @kindex monitor
12555 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12556 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12557 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12558 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12559 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12560 and implement.
12561 @end table
12562
12563 @node Server
12564 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12565
12566 @kindex gdbserver
12567 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12568 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12569 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12570 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12571
12572 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12573 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12574 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12575 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12576 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12577 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12578 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12579 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12580 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12581 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12582 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12583 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12584 choice for debugging.
12585
12586 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12587 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12588 protocol.
12589
12590 @table @emph
12591 @item On the target machine,
12592 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12593 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12594 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12595 system does all the symbol handling.
12596
12597 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12598 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12599 syntax is:
12600
12601 @smallexample
12602 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12603 @end smallexample
12604
12605 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12606 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12607 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12608 @file{/dev/com1}:
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12612 @end smallexample
12613
12614 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12615 with it.
12616
12617 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12618
12619 @smallexample
12620 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12621 @end smallexample
12622
12623 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12624 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12625 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12626 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12627 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12628 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12629 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12630 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12631 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12632 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12633 @code{target remote} command.
12634
12635 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12636 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12637
12638 @smallexample
12639 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12640 @end smallexample
12641
12642 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12643 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12644
12645 @pindex pidof
12646 @cindex attach to a program by name
12647 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12648 @code{pidof} utility:
12649
12650 @smallexample
12651 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12652 @end smallexample
12653
12654 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12655 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12656 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12657
12658 @item On the host machine,
12659 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12660 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12661 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12662 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12663 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12664 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12665 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12666 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12667 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12668 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12669 program is considered running after the connection.
12670
12671 @end table
12672
12673 @node Remote configuration
12674 @section Remote configuration
12675
12676 @kindex set remote
12677 @kindex show remote
12678 This section documents the configuration options available when
12679 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12680 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12681 system-call-allowed}.
12682
12683 @table @code
12684 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12685 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12686 @cindex bits in remote address
12687 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12688 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12689 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12690 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12691
12692 @item show remoteaddresssize
12693 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12694
12695 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12696 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12697 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12698 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12699 remote targets.
12700
12701 @item show remotebaud
12702 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12703
12704 @item set remotebreak
12705 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12706 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12707 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12708 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12709 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12710 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12711 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12712 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12713
12714 @item show remotebreak
12715 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12716 interrupt the remote program.
12717
12718 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12719 @cindex serial port name
12720 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12721 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12722 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12723 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12724 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12725 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12726 arguments.)
12727
12728 @item show remotedevice
12729 Show the current name of the serial port.
12730
12731 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12732 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12733 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12734 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12735 @code{ascii}.
12736
12737 @item show remotelogbase
12738 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12739 protocol.
12740
12741 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12742 @cindex record serial communications on file
12743 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12744 default is not to record at all.
12745
12746 @item show remotelogfile.
12747 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12748 serial communications.
12749
12750 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12751 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12752 @cindex remote timeout
12753 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12754 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12755
12756 @item show remotetimeout
12757 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12758 responses.
12759
12760 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12761 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12762 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12763 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12764 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12765 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12766 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12767 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12768 @end table
12769
12770 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12771 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12772 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12773 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12774 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12775 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12776 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12777 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12778 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12779
12780 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12781 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12782 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12783 @value{GDBN} developers.
12784
12785 The available settings are:
12786
12787 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12788 @item Command Name
12789 @tab Remote Packet
12790 @tab Related Features
12791
12792 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12793 @tab @code{p}
12794 @tab @code{info registers}
12795
12796 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12797 @tab @code{P}
12798 @tab @code{set}
12799
12800 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12801 @tab @code{X}
12802 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12803
12804 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12805 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12806 @tab @code{info auxv}
12807
12808 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12809 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12810 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12811
12812 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12813 @tab @code{vCont}
12814 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12815
12816 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12817 @tab @code{Z0}
12818 @tab @code{break}
12819
12820 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12821 @tab @code{Z1}
12822 @tab @code{hbreak}
12823
12824 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12825 @tab @code{Z2}
12826 @tab @code{watch}
12827
12828 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12829 @tab @code{Z3}
12830 @tab @code{rwatch}
12831
12832 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12833 @tab @code{Z4}
12834 @tab @code{awatch}
12835
12836 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12837 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12838 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12839
12840 @item @code{supported-packets}
12841 @tab @code{qSupported}
12842 @tab Remote communications parameters
12843
12844 @end multitable
12845
12846 @node remote stub
12847 @section Implementing a remote stub
12848
12849 @cindex debugging stub, example
12850 @cindex remote stub, example
12851 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12852 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12853 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12854 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12855 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12856 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12857 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12858 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12859
12860 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12861 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12862 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12863 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12864 program, you need:
12865
12866 @enumerate
12867 @item
12868 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12869 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12870 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12871
12872 @item
12873 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12874 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12875
12876 @item
12877 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12878 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12879 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12880 documentation.
12881 @end enumerate
12882
12883 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12884 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12885 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12886
12887 @table @emph
12888 @item On the host,
12889 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12890 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12891 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12892
12893 @item On the target,
12894 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12895 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12896 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12897
12898 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12899 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12900 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12901 @end table
12902
12903 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12904 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12905 @sc{sparc} boards.
12906
12907 @cindex remote serial stub list
12908 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12909
12910 @table @code
12911
12912 @item i386-stub.c
12913 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12914 @cindex Intel
12915 @cindex i386
12916 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12917
12918 @item m68k-stub.c
12919 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12920 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12921 @cindex m680x0
12922 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12923
12924 @item sh-stub.c
12925 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12926 @cindex Renesas
12927 @cindex SH
12928 For Renesas SH architectures.
12929
12930 @item sparc-stub.c
12931 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12932 @cindex Sparc
12933 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12934
12935 @item sparcl-stub.c
12936 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12937 @cindex Fujitsu
12938 @cindex SparcLite
12939 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12940
12941 @end table
12942
12943 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12944 recently added stubs.
12945
12946 @menu
12947 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12948 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12949 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12950 @end menu
12951
12952 @node Stub Contents
12953 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12954
12955 @cindex remote serial stub
12956 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12957 subroutines:
12958
12959 @table @code
12960 @item set_debug_traps
12961 @findex set_debug_traps
12962 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12963 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12964 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12965 beginning of your program.
12966
12967 @item handle_exception
12968 @findex handle_exception
12969 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12970 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12971 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12972 run when a trap is triggered.
12973
12974 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12975 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12976 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12977 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12978 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12979 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12980 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12981 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12982 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12983 machine.
12984
12985 @item breakpoint
12986 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12987 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12988 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12989 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12990 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12991 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12992 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12993 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12994 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12995 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
12996 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
12997
12998 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
12999 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13000 start of your debugging session.
13001 @end table
13002
13003 @node Bootstrapping
13004 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13005
13006 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13007 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13008 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13009 debugging target machine.
13010
13011 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13012 serial port.
13013
13014 @table @code
13015 @item int getDebugChar()
13016 @findex getDebugChar
13017 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13018 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13019 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13020
13021 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13022 @findex putDebugChar
13023 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13024 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13025 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13026 @end table
13027
13028 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13029 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13030 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13031 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13032 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13033 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13034 remote system to stop.
13035
13036 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13037 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13038 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13039 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13040
13041 Other routines you need to supply are:
13042
13043 @table @code
13044 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13045 @findex exceptionHandler
13046 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13047 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13048 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13049 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13050 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13051 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13052 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13053 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13054 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13055 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13056 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13057 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13058 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13059
13060 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13061 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13062 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13063 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13064 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13065
13066 @item void flush_i_cache()
13067 @findex flush_i_cache
13068 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13069 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13070 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13071
13072 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13073 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13074 @end table
13075
13076 @noindent
13077 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13078
13079 @table @code
13080 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13081 @findex memset
13082 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13083 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13084 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13085 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13086 @end table
13087
13088 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13089 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13090 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13091 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13092
13093
13094 @node Debug Session
13095 @subsection Putting it all together
13096
13097 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13098 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13099 steps.
13100
13101 @enumerate
13102 @item
13103 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13104 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13105 @display
13106 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13107 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13108 @end display
13109
13110 @item
13111 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13112
13113 @smallexample
13114 set_debug_traps();
13115 breakpoint();
13116 @end smallexample
13117
13118 @item
13119 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13120 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13121
13122 @smallexample
13123 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13124 @end smallexample
13125
13126 @noindent
13127 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13128 function in your program, that function is called when
13129 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13130 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13131 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13132
13133 @item
13134 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13135 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13136
13137 @item
13138 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13139 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13140
13141 @item
13142 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13143 @c document that. FIXME.
13144 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13145 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13146
13147 @item
13148 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13149 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13150
13151 @end enumerate
13152
13153 @node Configurations
13154 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13155
13156 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13157 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13158 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13159
13160 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13161 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13162 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13163 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13164 are quite different from each other.
13165
13166 @menu
13167 * Native::
13168 * Embedded OS::
13169 * Embedded Processors::
13170 * Architectures::
13171 @end menu
13172
13173 @node Native
13174 @section Native
13175
13176 This section describes details specific to particular native
13177 configurations.
13178
13179 @menu
13180 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13181 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13182 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13183 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13184 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13185 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13186 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13187 @end menu
13188
13189 @node HP-UX
13190 @subsection HP-UX
13191
13192 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13193 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13194 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13195
13196
13197 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13198 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13199
13200 @cindex libkvm
13201 @cindex kernel memory image
13202 @cindex kernel crash dump
13203
13204 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13205 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13206 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13207 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13208 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13209 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13210 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13211 @code{kvm} target:
13212
13213 @smallexample
13214 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13215 @end smallexample
13216
13217 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13218 argument:
13219
13220 @smallexample
13221 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13222 @end smallexample
13223
13224 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13225 available:
13226
13227 @table @code
13228 @kindex kvm
13229 @item kvm pcb
13230 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13231
13232 @item kvm proc
13233 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13234 modern FreeBSD systems.
13235 @end table
13236
13237 @node SVR4 Process Information
13238 @subsection SVR4 process information
13239 @cindex /proc
13240 @cindex examine process image
13241 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13242
13243 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13244 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13245 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13246 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13247 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13248 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13249 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13250 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13251 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13252
13253 @table @code
13254 @kindex info proc
13255 @cindex process ID
13256 @item info proc
13257 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13258 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13259 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13260 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13261 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13262 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13263 executable file's absolute file name.
13264
13265 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13266 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13267 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13268 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13269 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13270 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13271
13272 @item info proc mappings
13273 @cindex memory address space mappings
13274 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13275 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13276 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13277 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13278 memory access rights to that range.
13279
13280 @item info proc stat
13281 @itemx info proc status
13282 @cindex process detailed status information
13283 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13284 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13285 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13286 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13287 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13288 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13289 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13290
13291 @item info proc all
13292 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13293 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13294
13295 @ignore
13296 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13297 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13298 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13299 @kindex info proc times
13300 @item info proc times
13301 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13302 its children.
13303
13304 @kindex info proc id
13305 @item info proc id
13306 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13307 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13308 @end ignore
13309
13310 @item set procfs-trace
13311 @kindex set procfs-trace
13312 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13313 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13314
13315 @item show procfs-trace
13316 @kindex show procfs-trace
13317 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13318
13319 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13320 @kindex set procfs-file
13321 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13322 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13323 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13324 standard output.
13325
13326 @item show procfs-file
13327 @kindex show procfs-file
13328 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13329
13330 @item proc-trace-entry
13331 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13332 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13333 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13334 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13335 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13336 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13337 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13338 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13339 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13340
13341 @item info pidlist
13342 @kindex info pidlist
13343 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13344 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13345 processes and all the threads within each process.
13346
13347 @item info meminfo
13348 @kindex info meminfo
13349 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13350 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13351 @end table
13352
13353 @node DJGPP Native
13354 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13355 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13356 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13357 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13358
13359 @cindex DPMI
13360 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13361 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13362 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13363 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13364
13365 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13366 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13367 subsection describes those commands.
13368
13369 @table @code
13370 @kindex info dos
13371 @item info dos
13372 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13373 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13374
13375 @kindex sysinfo
13376 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13377 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13378 @item info dos sysinfo
13379 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13380 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13381 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13382
13383 @cindex GDT
13384 @cindex LDT
13385 @cindex IDT
13386 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13387 @cindex descriptor tables display
13388 @item info dos gdt
13389 @itemx info dos ldt
13390 @itemx info dos idt
13391 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13392 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13393 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13394 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13395 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13396 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13397 rights.
13398
13399 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13400 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13401 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13402 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13403 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13404
13405 @cindex garbled pointers
13406 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13407 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13408 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13409 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13410 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13411 debugged program's data segment:
13412
13413 @smallexample
13414 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13415 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13416 @end smallexample
13417
13418 @noindent
13419 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13420 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13421
13422 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13423 @item info dos pde
13424 @itemx info dos pte
13425 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13426 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13427 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13428 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13429 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13430 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13431 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13432 that is currently in use.
13433
13434 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13435 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13436 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13437 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13438 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13439 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13440 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13441
13442 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13443 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13444 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13445 controller.
13446
13447 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13448
13449 @cindex physical address from linear address
13450 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13451 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13452 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13453 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13454 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13455 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13456 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13457
13458 @smallexample
13459 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13460 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13461 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13462 @end smallexample
13463
13464 @noindent
13465 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13466 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13467 attributes of that page.
13468
13469 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13470 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13471 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13472 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13473 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13474 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13475
13476 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13477 transfer buffer:
13478
13479 @smallexample
13480 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13481 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13482 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13483 @end smallexample
13484
13485 @noindent
13486 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13487 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13488 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13489 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13490 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13491
13492 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13493 @end table
13494
13495 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13496 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13497 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13498 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13499
13500 @table @code
13501 @kindex set com1base
13502 @kindex set com1irq
13503 @kindex set com2base
13504 @kindex set com2irq
13505 @kindex set com3base
13506 @kindex set com3irq
13507 @kindex set com4base
13508 @kindex set com4irq
13509 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13510 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13511 port.
13512
13513 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13514 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13515 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13516
13517 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13518 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13519 other 3 COM ports.
13520
13521 @kindex show com1base
13522 @kindex show com1irq
13523 @kindex show com2base
13524 @kindex show com2irq
13525 @kindex show com3base
13526 @kindex show com3irq
13527 @kindex show com4base
13528 @kindex show com4irq
13529 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13530 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13531 lines used by the COM ports.
13532
13533 @item info serial
13534 @kindex info serial
13535 @cindex DOS serial port status
13536 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13537 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13538 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13539 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13540 @end table
13541
13542
13543 @node Cygwin Native
13544 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13545 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13546 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13547 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13548
13549 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13550 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13551 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13552 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13553 that have no debugging symbols.
13554
13555
13556 @table @code
13557 @kindex info w32
13558 @item info w32
13559 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13560 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13561
13562 @item info w32 selector
13563 This command displays information returned by
13564 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13565 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13566 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13567 Without argument, this command displays information
13568 about the the six segment registers.
13569
13570 @kindex info dll
13571 @item info dll
13572 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13573
13574 @kindex dll-symbols
13575 @item dll-symbols
13576 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13577 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13578
13579 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13580 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13581 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13582 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13583 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13584 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13585 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13586 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13587 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13588 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13589 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13590
13591 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13592 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13593 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13594 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13595
13596 @kindex set new-console
13597 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13598 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13599 be started in a new console on next start.
13600 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13601 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13602
13603 @kindex show new-console
13604 @item show new-console
13605 Displays whether a new console is used
13606 when the debuggee is started.
13607
13608 @kindex set new-group
13609 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13610 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13611 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13612 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13613 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13614
13615 @kindex show new-group
13616 @item show new-group
13617 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13618
13619 @kindex set debugevents
13620 @item set debugevents
13621 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13622 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13623 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13624 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13625 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13626
13627 @kindex set debugexec
13628 @item set debugexec
13629 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13630 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13631
13632 @kindex set debugexceptions
13633 @item set debugexceptions
13634 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13635 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13636
13637 @kindex set debugmemory
13638 @item set debugmemory
13639 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13640 and writes by the debugger.
13641
13642 @kindex set shell
13643 @item set shell
13644 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13645 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13646
13647 @kindex show shell
13648 @item show shell
13649 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13650
13651 @end table
13652
13653 @menu
13654 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13655 @end menu
13656
13657 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13658 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13659 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13660 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13661
13662 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13663 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13664 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13665 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13666 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13667 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13668 ``minimal symbols''.
13669
13670 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13671 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13672 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13673 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13674 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13675 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13676 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13677 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13678 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13679 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13680
13681 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13682
13683 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13684 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13685 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13686 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13687 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13688 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13689 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13690 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13691 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13692
13693 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13694 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13695 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13696 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13697 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13698 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13699
13700 @smallexample
13701 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13702 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13703
13704 Non-debugging symbols:
13705 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13706 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13707 @end smallexample
13708
13709 @smallexample
13710 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13711 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13712
13713 Non-debugging symbols:
13714 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13715 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13716 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13717 [etc...]
13718 @end smallexample
13719
13720 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13721
13722 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13723 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13724 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13725 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13726 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13727 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13728 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13729
13730 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13731 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13732 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13733 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13734 problem:
13735
13736 @smallexample
13737 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13738 $1 = 268572168
13739 @end smallexample
13740
13741 @smallexample
13742 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13743 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13744 @end smallexample
13745
13746 And two possible solutions:
13747
13748 @smallexample
13749 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13750 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13751 @end smallexample
13752
13753 @smallexample
13754 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13755 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13756 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13757 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13758 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13759 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13760 @end smallexample
13761
13762 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13763 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13764 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13765 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13766 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13767
13768 @smallexample
13769 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13770 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13771 @end smallexample
13772
13773 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13774 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13775 safe.
13776
13777 @node Hurd Native
13778 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13779 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13780
13781 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13782 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13783
13784 @table @code
13785 @item set signals
13786 @itemx set sigs
13787 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13788 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13789 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13790 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13791 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13792 @code{signals}.
13793
13794 @item show signals
13795 @itemx show sigs
13796 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13797 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13798 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13799
13800 @item set signal-thread
13801 @itemx set sigthread
13802 @kindex set signal-thread
13803 @kindex set sigthread
13804 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13805 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13806 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13807 signal-thread}.
13808
13809 @item show signal-thread
13810 @itemx show sigthread
13811 @kindex show signal-thread
13812 @kindex show sigthread
13813 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13814 delivered a signal.
13815
13816 @item set stopped
13817 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13818 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13819 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13820 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13821
13822 @item show stopped
13823 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13824 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13825 stopped.
13826
13827 @item set exceptions
13828 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13829 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13830 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13831 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13832 trapping on.
13833
13834 @item show exceptions
13835 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13836 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13837
13838 @item set task pause
13839 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13840 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13841 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13842 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13843 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13844 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13845 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13846 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13847 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13848
13849 @item show task pause
13850 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13851 Show the current state of task suspension.
13852
13853 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13854 @cindex task suspend count
13855 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13856 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13857 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13858
13859 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13860 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13861
13862 @item set task exception-port
13863 @itemx set task excp
13864 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13865 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13866 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13867 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13868
13869 @item set noninvasive
13870 @cindex noninvasive task options
13871 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13872 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13873 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13874 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13875
13876 @item info send-rights
13877 @itemx info receive-rights
13878 @itemx info port-rights
13879 @itemx info port-sets
13880 @itemx info dead-names
13881 @itemx info ports
13882 @itemx info psets
13883 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13884 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13885 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13886 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13887 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13888 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13889 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13890 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13891 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13892
13893 @item set thread pause
13894 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13895 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13896 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13897 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13898 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13899 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13900 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13901 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13902 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13903 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13904 only the current thread.
13905
13906 @item show thread pause
13907 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13908 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13909
13910 @item set thread run
13911 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13912
13913 @item show thread run
13914 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13915
13916 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13917 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13918 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13919 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13920 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13921 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13922 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13923
13924 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13925 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13926 detaching.
13927
13928 @item set thread exception-port
13929 @itemx set thread excp
13930 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13931 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13932 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13933
13934 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13935 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13936 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13937 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13938
13939 @item set thread default
13940 @itemx show thread default
13941 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13942 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13943 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13944 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13945 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13946 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13947 the non-default commands.
13948 @end table
13949
13950
13951 @node Neutrino
13952 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13953 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13954
13955 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13956 Neutrino target:
13957
13958 @table @code
13959 @item set debug nto-debug
13960 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13961 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13962 Neutrino support.
13963
13964 @item show debug nto-debug
13965 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13966 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13967 @end table
13968
13969
13970 @node Embedded OS
13971 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13972
13973 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13974 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13975 architectures.
13976
13977 @menu
13978 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13979 @end menu
13980
13981 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13982 various real-time operating systems.
13983
13984 @node VxWorks
13985 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13986
13987 @cindex VxWorks
13988
13989 @table @code
13990
13991 @kindex target vxworks
13992 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13993 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13994 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13995
13996 @end table
13997
13998 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
13999 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14000
14001 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14002 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14003 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14004 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14005 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14006 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14007 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14008
14009 @table @code
14010 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14011 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14012 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14013 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14014 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14015 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14016 of a thin network line.
14017 @end table
14018
14019 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14020 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14021 procedures.
14022
14023 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14024 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14025 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14026 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14027 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14028 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14029 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14030 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14031 manual.
14032 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14033
14034 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14035 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14036 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14037 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14038
14039 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14040
14041 @smallexample
14042 (vxgdb)
14043 @end smallexample
14044
14045 @menu
14046 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14047 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14048 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14049 @end menu
14050
14051 @node VxWorks Connection
14052 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14053
14054 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14055 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14056
14057 @smallexample
14058 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14059 @end smallexample
14060
14061 @need 750
14062 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14063
14064 @smallexample
14065 Attaching remote machine across net...
14066 Connected to tt.
14067 @end smallexample
14068
14069 @need 1000
14070 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14071 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14072 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14073 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14074 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14075
14076 @smallexample
14077 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14078 @end smallexample
14079
14080 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14081 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14082 command again.
14083
14084 @node VxWorks Download
14085 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14086
14087 @cindex download to VxWorks
14088 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14089 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14090 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14091 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14092 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14093 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14094 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14095 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14096 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14097 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14098 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14099 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14100 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14101 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14102 program, type this on VxWorks:
14103
14104 @smallexample
14105 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14106 @end smallexample
14107
14108 @noindent
14109 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14110
14111 @smallexample
14112 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14113 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14114 @end smallexample
14115
14116 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14117
14118 @smallexample
14119 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14120 @end smallexample
14121
14122 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14123 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14124 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14125 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14126 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14127 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14128 table.)
14129
14130 @node VxWorks Attach
14131 @subsubsection Running tasks
14132
14133 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14134 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14135 follows:
14136
14137 @smallexample
14138 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14139 @end smallexample
14140
14141 @noindent
14142 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14143 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14144 the time of attachment.
14145
14146 @node Embedded Processors
14147 @section Embedded Processors
14148
14149 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14150 configurations.
14151
14152 @cindex send command to simulator
14153 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14154 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14155
14156 @table @code
14157 @item sim @var{command}
14158 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14159 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14160 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14161 acceptable commands.
14162 @end table
14163
14164
14165 @menu
14166 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14167 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14168 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14169 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14170 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14171 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14172 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14173 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14174 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14175 * SH:: Renesas SH
14176 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14177 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14178 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14179 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14180 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14181 * CRIS:: CRIS
14182 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14183 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14184 @end menu
14185
14186 @node ARM
14187 @subsection ARM
14188 @cindex ARM RDI
14189
14190 @table @code
14191 @kindex target rdi
14192 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14193 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14194 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14195 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14196
14197 @kindex target rdp
14198 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14199 ARM Demon monitor.
14200
14201 @end table
14202
14203 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14204
14205 @table @code
14206 @item set arm disassembler
14207 @kindex set arm
14208 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14209 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14210
14211 @item show arm disassembler
14212 @kindex show arm
14213 Show the current disassembly style.
14214
14215 @item set arm apcs32
14216 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14217 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14218
14219 @item show arm apcs32
14220 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14221
14222 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14223 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14224 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14225
14226 @table @code
14227 @item auto
14228 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14229 @item softfpa
14230 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14231 processors.
14232 @item fpa
14233 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14234 @item softvfp
14235 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14236 @item vfp
14237 VFP co-processor.
14238 @end table
14239
14240 @item show arm fpu
14241 Show the current type of the FPU.
14242
14243 @item set arm abi
14244 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14245
14246 @item show arm abi
14247 Show the currently used ABI.
14248
14249 @item set debug arm
14250 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14251 target support subsystem.
14252
14253 @item show debug arm
14254 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14255 @end table
14256
14257 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14258 using the RDI interface:
14259
14260 @table @code
14261 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14262 @kindex rdilogfile
14263 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14264 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14265 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14266 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14267 @file{rdi.log}.
14268
14269 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14270 @kindex rdilogenable
14271 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14272 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14273 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14274 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14275 are logged to a file.
14276
14277 @item set rdiromatzero
14278 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14279 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14280 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14281 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14282 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14283 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14284
14285 @item show rdiromatzero
14286 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14287 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14288
14289 @item set rdiheartbeat
14290 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14291 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14292 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14293 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14294 well as the Angel monitor.
14295
14296 @item show rdiheartbeat
14297 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14298 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14299 @end table
14300
14301
14302 @node H8/300
14303 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14304
14305 @table @code
14306
14307 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14308 @item target hms @var{dev}
14309 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14310 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14311 line and the communications speed used.
14312
14313 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14314 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14315 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14316
14317 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14318 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14319 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14320 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14321 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14322
14323 @end table
14324
14325 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14326 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14327 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14328 @cindex Renesas SH download
14329 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14330 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14331 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14332 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14333
14334 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14335 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14336
14337 @enumerate
14338 @item
14339 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14340 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14341 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14342 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14343 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14344
14345 @item
14346 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14347 serial device available on your host is the default).
14348
14349 @item
14350 what speed to use over the serial device.
14351 @end enumerate
14352
14353 @menu
14354 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14355 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14356 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14357 @end menu
14358
14359 @node Renesas Boards
14360 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14361
14362 @c only for Unix hosts
14363 @kindex device
14364 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14365 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14366 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14367 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14368 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14369
14370 @kindex speed
14371 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14372 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14373 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14374 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14375 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14376 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14377
14378 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14379 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14380 use a DOS host,
14381 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14382 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14383 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14384 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14385
14386 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14387 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14388 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14389 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14390
14391 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14392 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14393 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14394 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14395 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14396 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14397 @code{COM2}.
14398
14399 @smallexample
14400 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14401 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14402
14403 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14404
14405 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14406
14407 @end smallexample
14408
14409 @quotation
14410 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14411 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14412 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14413 your development board.
14414 @end quotation
14415
14416 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14417 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14418 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14419 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14420 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14421 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14422 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14423 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14424 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14425 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14426 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14427 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14428 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14429
14430 @smallexample
14431 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14432 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14433 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14434 the conditions.
14435 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14436 for details.
14437 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14438 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14439 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14440 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14441 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14442 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14443 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14444 @end smallexample
14445
14446 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14447 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14448 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14449 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14450 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14451 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14452
14453 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14454 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14455 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14456
14457 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14458 @itemize @bullet
14459 @item
14460 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14461 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14462
14463 @item
14464 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14465 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14466 to detect program completion.
14467 @end itemize
14468
14469 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14470 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14471
14472 @node Renesas ICE
14473 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14474
14475 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14476 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14477 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14478 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14479
14480 @table @code
14481 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14482 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14483 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14484 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14485 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14486
14487 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14488 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14489 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14490 @end table
14491
14492 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14493 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14494
14495 @table @code
14496 @item e7000 @var{command}
14497 @kindex e7000
14498 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14499 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14500
14501 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14502 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14503 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14504 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14505 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14506 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14507
14508 @item ftpload @var{file}
14509 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14510 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14511 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14512
14513 @item drain
14514 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14515 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14516
14517 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14518 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14519 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14520 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14521 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14522 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14523 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14524 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14525 @end table
14526
14527 @node Renesas Special
14528 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14529
14530 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14531
14532 @table @code
14533
14534 @kindex set machine
14535 @kindex show machine
14536 @item set machine h8300
14537 @itemx set machine h8300h
14538 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14539 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14540 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14541
14542 @end table
14543
14544 @node H8/500
14545 @subsection H8/500
14546
14547 @table @code
14548
14549 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14550 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14551 @item set memory @var{mod}
14552 @itemx show memory
14553 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14554 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14555 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14556 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14557
14558 @end table
14559
14560 @node M32R/D
14561 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14562
14563 @table @code
14564 @kindex target m32r
14565 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14566 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14567
14568 @kindex target m32rsdi
14569 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14570 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14571 @end table
14572
14573 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14574
14575 @table @code
14576 @item set download-path @var{path}
14577 @kindex set download-path
14578 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14579 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14580
14581 @item show download-path
14582 @kindex show download-path
14583 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14584
14585 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14586 @kindex set board-address
14587 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14588 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14589
14590 @item show board-address
14591 @kindex show board-address
14592 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14593
14594 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14595 @kindex set server-address
14596 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14597 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14598 host machine.
14599
14600 @item show server-address
14601 @kindex show server-address
14602 Display the IP address of the download server.
14603
14604 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14605 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14606 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14607 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14608 executable file is uploaded.
14609
14610 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14611 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14612 Test the @code{upload} command.
14613 @end table
14614
14615 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14616
14617 @table @code
14618 @item sdireset
14619 @kindex sdireset
14620 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14621 This command resets the SDI connection.
14622
14623 @item sdistatus
14624 @kindex sdistatus
14625 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14626
14627 @item debug_chaos
14628 @kindex debug_chaos
14629 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14630 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14631
14632 @item use_debug_dma
14633 @kindex use_debug_dma
14634 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14635
14636 @item use_mon_code
14637 @kindex use_mon_code
14638 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14639
14640 @item use_ib_break
14641 @kindex use_ib_break
14642 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14643
14644 @item use_dbt_break
14645 @kindex use_dbt_break
14646 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14647 @end table
14648
14649 @node M68K
14650 @subsection M68k
14651
14652 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14653 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14654
14655 @table @code
14656
14657 @kindex target abug
14658 @item target abug @var{dev}
14659 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14660
14661 @kindex target cpu32bug
14662 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14663 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14664
14665 @kindex target dbug
14666 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14667 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14668
14669 @kindex target est
14670 @item target est @var{dev}
14671 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14672
14673 @kindex target rom68k
14674 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14675 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14676
14677 @end table
14678
14679 @table @code
14680
14681 @kindex target rombug
14682 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14683 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14684
14685 @end table
14686
14687 @node MIPS Embedded
14688 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14689
14690 @cindex MIPS boards
14691 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14692 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14693 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14694
14695 @need 1000
14696 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14697
14698 @table @code
14699 @item target mips @var{port}
14700 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14701 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14702 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14703 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14704 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14705 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14706 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14707
14708 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14709 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14710 debugger:
14711
14712 @smallexample
14713 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14714 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14715 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14716 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14717 (@value{GDBP}) run
14718 @end smallexample
14719
14720 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14721 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14722 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14723 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14724 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14725
14726 @item target pmon @var{port}
14727 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14728 PMON ROM monitor.
14729
14730 @item target ddb @var{port}
14731 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14732 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14733
14734 @item target lsi @var{port}
14735 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14736 LSI variant of PMON.
14737
14738 @kindex target r3900
14739 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14740 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14741
14742 @kindex target array
14743 @item target array @var{dev}
14744 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14745
14746 @end table
14747
14748
14749 @noindent
14750 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14751
14752 @table @code
14753 @item set mipsfpu double
14754 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14755 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14756 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14757 @itemx show mipsfpu
14758 @kindex set mipsfpu
14759 @kindex show mipsfpu
14760 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14761 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14762 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14763 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14764 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14765 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14766 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14767 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14768 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14769 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14770 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14771 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14772 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14773
14774 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14775 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14776 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14777
14778 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14779 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14780
14781 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14782 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14783 @itemx show timeout
14784 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14785 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14786 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14787 @kindex set timeout
14788 @kindex show timeout
14789 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14790 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14791 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14792 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14793 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14794 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14795 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14796 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14797 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14798 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14799
14800 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14801 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14802 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14803 to run before stopping.
14804
14805 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14806 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14807 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14808 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14809 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14810 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14811
14812 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14813 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14814 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14815 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14816
14817 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14818 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14819 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14820 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14821 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14822 @table @asis
14823 @item pmon target
14824 @samp{PMON}
14825 @item ddb target
14826 @samp{NEC010}
14827 @item lsi target
14828 @samp{PMON>}
14829 @end table
14830
14831 @item show monitor-prompt
14832 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14833 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14834 remote monitor.
14835
14836 @item set monitor-warnings
14837 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14838 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14839 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14840 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14841 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14842
14843 @item show monitor-warnings
14844 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14845 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14846
14847 @item pmon @var{command}
14848 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14849 @cindex send PMON command
14850 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14851 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14852 @end table
14853
14854 @node OpenRISC 1000
14855 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14856 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14857
14858 @cindex or1k boards
14859 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14860 about platform and commands.
14861
14862 @table @code
14863
14864 @kindex target jtag
14865 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14866
14867 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14868 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14869 connected via parallel port to the board.
14870
14871 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14872
14873 @kindex or1ksim
14874 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14875 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14876 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14877
14878 @kindex info or1k spr
14879 @item info or1k spr
14880 Displays spr groups.
14881
14882 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14883 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14884 Displays register names in selected group.
14885
14886 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14887 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14888 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14889 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14890 Shows information about specified spr register.
14891
14892 @kindex spr
14893 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14894 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14895 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14896 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14897 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14898 @end table
14899
14900 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14901 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14902 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14903 triggers can be set using:
14904 @table @code
14905 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14906 Load effective address/data
14907 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14908 Store effective address/data
14909 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14910 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14911 @item $FETCH
14912 Fetch data
14913 @end table
14914
14915 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14916 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14917
14918 @code{htrace} commands:
14919 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14920 @table @code
14921 @kindex hwatch
14922 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14923 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14924 or Data. For example:
14925
14926 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14927
14928 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14929
14930 @kindex htrace
14931 @item htrace info
14932 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14933
14934 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14935 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14936
14937 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14938 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14939
14940 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14941 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14942
14943 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14944 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14945 triggered.
14946
14947 @item htrace enable
14948 @itemx htrace disable
14949 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14950
14951 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14952 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14953
14954 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14955 will be written there.
14956
14957 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14958 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14959
14960 @item htrace mode continuous
14961 Set continuous trace mode.
14962
14963 @item htrace mode suspend
14964 Set suspend trace mode.
14965
14966 @end table
14967
14968 @node PowerPC
14969 @subsection PowerPC
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @kindex target dink32
14973 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14974 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14975
14976 @kindex target ppcbug
14977 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14978 @kindex target ppcbug1
14979 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14980 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14981
14982 @kindex target sds
14983 @item target sds @var{dev}
14984 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14985 @end table
14986
14987 @cindex SDS protocol
14988 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14989 by@value{GDBN}:
14990
14991 @table @code
14992 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14993 @kindex set sdstimeout
14994 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14995 default is 2 seconds.
14996
14997 @item show sdstimeout
14998 @kindex show sdstimeout
14999 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15000
15001 @item sds @var{command}
15002 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15003 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15004 @end table
15005
15006
15007 @node PA
15008 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15009
15010 @table @code
15011
15012 @kindex target op50n
15013 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15014 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15015
15016 @kindex target w89k
15017 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15018 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15019
15020 @end table
15021
15022 @node SH
15023 @subsection Renesas SH
15024
15025 @table @code
15026
15027 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15028 @item target hms @var{dev}
15029 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15030 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15031 the communications speed used.
15032
15033 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15034 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15035 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15036
15037 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15038 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15039 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15040 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15041 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15042
15043 @end table
15044
15045 @node Sparclet
15046 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15047
15048 @cindex Sparclet
15049
15050 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15051 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15052 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15053 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15054 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15055
15056 @table @code
15057 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15058 @kindex remotetimeout
15059 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15060 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15061 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15062 @end table
15063
15064 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15065 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15066 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15067 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15068 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15069
15070 @smallexample
15071 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15072 @end smallexample
15073
15074 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15075
15076 @smallexample
15077 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15078 @end smallexample
15079
15080 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15081 Once you have set
15082 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15083 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15084 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15085
15086 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15087
15088 @smallexample
15089 (gdbslet)
15090 @end smallexample
15091
15092 @menu
15093 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15094 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15095 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15096 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15097 @end menu
15098
15099 @node Sparclet File
15100 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15101
15102 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15103
15104 @smallexample
15105 (gdbslet) file prog
15106 @end smallexample
15107
15108 @need 1000
15109 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15110 @value{GDBN} locates
15111 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15112 path.
15113 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15114 files will be searched as well.
15115 @value{GDBN} locates
15116 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15117 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15118 If it fails
15119 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15120
15121 @smallexample
15122 prog: No such file or directory.
15123 @end smallexample
15124
15125 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15126 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15127 @code{target} command again.
15128
15129 @node Sparclet Connection
15130 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15131
15132 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15133 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15134
15135 @smallexample
15136 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15137 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15138 main () at ../prog.c:3
15139 @end smallexample
15140
15141 @need 750
15142 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15143
15144 @smallexample
15145 Connected to ttya.
15146 @end smallexample
15147
15148 @node Sparclet Download
15149 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15150
15151 @cindex download to Sparclet
15152 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15153 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15154 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15155 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15156 command.
15157 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15158 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15159 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15160 of each of the file's sections.
15161 For instance, if the program
15162 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15163 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15164
15165 @smallexample
15166 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15167 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15168 @end smallexample
15169
15170 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15171 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15172 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15173
15174 @node Sparclet Execution
15175 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15176
15177 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15178 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15179 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15180 manual for the list of commands.
15181
15182 @smallexample
15183 (gdbslet) b main
15184 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15185 (gdbslet) run
15186 Starting program: prog
15187 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15188 3 char *symarg = 0;
15189 (gdbslet) step
15190 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15191 (gdbslet)
15192 @end smallexample
15193
15194 @node Sparclite
15195 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15196
15197 @table @code
15198
15199 @kindex target sparclite
15200 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15201 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15202 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15203 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15204 remote protocol.
15205
15206 @end table
15207
15208 @node ST2000
15209 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15210
15211 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15212 STDBUG protocol.
15213
15214 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15215 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15216
15217 @smallexample
15218 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15219 @end smallexample
15220
15221 @noindent
15222 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15223 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15224 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15225 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15226 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15227
15228 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15229 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15230 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15231 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15232 available on your host computer.
15233 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15234 @c basically hearsay.
15235
15236 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15237 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15238 environment:
15239
15240 @table @code
15241 @item st2000 @var{command}
15242 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15243 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15244 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15245 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15246 manual for available commands.
15247
15248 @item connect
15249 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15250 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15251 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15252 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15253 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15254 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ Ctrl-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15255 @end table
15256
15257 @node Z8000
15258 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15259
15260 @cindex Z8000
15261 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15262 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15263
15264 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15265 a Z8000 simulator.
15266
15267 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15268 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15269 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15270 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15271
15272 @table @code
15273 @item target sim @var{args}
15274 @kindex sim
15275 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15276 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15277 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15278 @end table
15279
15280 @noindent
15281 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15282 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15283 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15284 to run your program, and so on.
15285
15286 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15287 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15288 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15289
15290 @table @code
15291
15292 @item cycles
15293 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15294
15295 @item insts
15296 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15297
15298 @item time
15299 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15300
15301 @end table
15302
15303 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15304 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15305 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15306 simulated clock ticks.
15307
15308 @node AVR
15309 @subsection Atmel AVR
15310 @cindex AVR
15311
15312 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15313 following AVR-specific commands:
15314
15315 @table @code
15316 @item info io_registers
15317 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15318 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15319 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15320 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15321 @end table
15322
15323 @node CRIS
15324 @subsection CRIS
15325 @cindex CRIS
15326
15327 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15328 following CRIS-specific commands:
15329
15330 @table @code
15331 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15332 @cindex CRIS version
15333 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15334 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15335 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15336
15337 @item show cris-version
15338 Show the current CRIS version.
15339
15340 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15341 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15342 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15343 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15344 @code{R59}.
15345
15346 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15347 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15348
15349 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15350 @cindex CRIS mode
15351 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15352 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15353 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15354
15355 @item show cris-mode
15356 Show the current CRIS mode.
15357 @end table
15358
15359 @node Super-H
15360 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15361 @cindex Super-H
15362
15363 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15364 commands:
15365
15366 @table @code
15367 @item regs
15368 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15369 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15370 @end table
15371
15372 @node WinCE
15373 @subsection Windows CE
15374 @cindex Windows CE
15375
15376 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15377
15378 @table @code
15379 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15380 @kindex set remotedirectory
15381 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15382 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15383 drive.
15384
15385 @item show remotedirectory
15386 @kindex show remotedirectory
15387 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15388
15389 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15390 @kindex set remoteupload
15391 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15392 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15393 The default is @samp{newer}.
15394
15395 @item show remoteupload
15396 @kindex show remoteupload
15397 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15398
15399 @item set remoteaddhost
15400 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15401 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15402 arguments when you debug over a network.
15403
15404 @item show remoteaddhost
15405 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15406 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15407 debugging over a network.
15408 @end table
15409
15410
15411 @node Architectures
15412 @section Architectures
15413
15414 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15415 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15416
15417 @menu
15418 * i386::
15419 * A29K::
15420 * Alpha::
15421 * MIPS::
15422 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15423 @end menu
15424
15425 @node i386
15426 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15427
15428 @table @code
15429 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15430 @kindex set struct-convention
15431 @cindex struct return convention
15432 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15433 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15434 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15435 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15436 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15437 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15438 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15439 be returned in a register.
15440
15441 @item show struct-convention
15442 @kindex show struct-convention
15443 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15444 from functions.
15445 @end table
15446
15447 @node A29K
15448 @subsection A29K
15449
15450 @table @code
15451
15452 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15453 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15454 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15455 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15456 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15457 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15458 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15459 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15460 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15461 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15462 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15463 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15464 hexadecimal.
15465
15466 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15467 @item show rstack_high_address
15468 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15469 processors.
15470
15471 @end table
15472
15473 @node Alpha
15474 @subsection Alpha
15475
15476 See the following section.
15477
15478 @node MIPS
15479 @subsection MIPS
15480
15481 @cindex stack on Alpha
15482 @cindex stack on MIPS
15483 @cindex Alpha stack
15484 @cindex MIPS stack
15485 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15486 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15487 find the beginning of a function.
15488
15489 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15490 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15491 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15492 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15493 commands:
15494
15495 @table @code
15496 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15497 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15498 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15499 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15500 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15501 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15502 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15503 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15504
15505 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15506 Display the current limit.
15507 @end table
15508
15509 @noindent
15510 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15511 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15512
15513 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15514 programs:
15515
15516 @table @code
15517 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15518 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15519 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15520 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15521 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15522
15523 @table @samp
15524 @item 32
15525 32-bit GP registers
15526 @item 64
15527 64-bit GP registers
15528 @item auto
15529 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15530 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15531 @end table
15532
15533 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15534 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15535 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15536
15537 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15538 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15539 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15540 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15541 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15542 (the default).
15543
15544 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15545 @kindex set mips abi
15546 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15547 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15548 values of @var{arg} are:
15549
15550 @table @samp
15551 @item auto
15552 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15553 default).
15554 @item o32
15555 @item o64
15556 @item n32
15557 @item n64
15558 @item eabi32
15559 @item eabi64
15560 @item auto
15561 @end table
15562
15563 @item show mips abi
15564 @kindex show mips abi
15565 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15566
15567 @item set mipsfpu
15568 @itemx show mipsfpu
15569 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15570
15571 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15572 @kindex set mips mask-address
15573 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15574 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15575 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15576 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15577 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15578
15579 @item show mips mask-address
15580 @kindex show mips mask-address
15581 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15582 not.
15583
15584 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15585 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15586 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15587 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15588 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15589 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15590
15591 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15592 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15593 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15594
15595 @item set debug mips
15596 @kindex set debug mips
15597 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15598 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15599
15600 @item show debug mips
15601 @kindex show debug mips
15602 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15603 @end table
15604
15605
15606 @node HPPA
15607 @subsection HPPA
15608 @cindex HPPA support
15609
15610 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15611 following special commands:
15612
15613 @table @code
15614 @item set debug hppa
15615 @kindex set debug hppa
15616 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15617 messages are to be displayed.
15618
15619 @item show debug hppa
15620 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15621
15622 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15623 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15624 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15625 given @var{address}.
15626
15627 @end table
15628
15629
15630 @node Controlling GDB
15631 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15632
15633 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15634 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15635 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15636 described here.
15637
15638 @menu
15639 * Prompt:: Prompt
15640 * Editing:: Command editing
15641 * Command History:: Command history
15642 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15643 * Numbers:: Numbers
15644 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15645 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15646 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15647 @end menu
15648
15649 @node Prompt
15650 @section Prompt
15651
15652 @cindex prompt
15653
15654 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15655 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15656 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15657 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15658 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15659 which one you are talking to.
15660
15661 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15662 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15663 or a prompt that does not.
15664
15665 @table @code
15666 @kindex set prompt
15667 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15668 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15669
15670 @kindex show prompt
15671 @item show prompt
15672 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15673 @end table
15674
15675 @node Editing
15676 @section Command editing
15677 @cindex readline
15678 @cindex command line editing
15679
15680 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15681 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15682 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15683 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15684 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15685 debugging sessions.
15686
15687 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15688 command @code{set}.
15689
15690 @table @code
15691 @kindex set editing
15692 @cindex editing
15693 @item set editing
15694 @itemx set editing on
15695 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15696
15697 @item set editing off
15698 Disable command line editing.
15699
15700 @kindex show editing
15701 @item show editing
15702 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15703 @end table
15704
15705 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15706 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15707 encouraged to read that chapter.
15708
15709 @node Command History
15710 @section Command history
15711 @cindex command history
15712
15713 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15714 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15715 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15716 history facility.
15717
15718 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15719 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15720 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15721
15722 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15723 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15724 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15725 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15726 pressed on a line by itself.
15727
15728 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15729 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15730 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15731 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15732
15733 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15734 history.
15735
15736 @table @code
15737 @cindex history substitution
15738 @cindex history file
15739 @kindex set history filename
15740 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15741 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15742 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15743 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15744 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15745 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15746 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15747 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15748 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15749 is not set.
15750
15751 @cindex save command history
15752 @kindex set history save
15753 @item set history save
15754 @itemx set history save on
15755 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15756 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15757
15758 @item set history save off
15759 Stop recording command history in a file.
15760
15761 @cindex history size
15762 @kindex set history size
15763 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15764 @item set history size @var{size}
15765 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15766 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15767 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15768 @end table
15769
15770 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15771 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15772
15773 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15774 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15775 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15776 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15777 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15778 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15779 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15780 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15781
15782 The commands to control history expansion are:
15783
15784 @table @code
15785 @item set history expansion on
15786 @itemx set history expansion
15787 @kindex set history expansion
15788 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15789
15790 @item set history expansion off
15791 Disable history expansion.
15792
15793 @c @group
15794 @kindex show history
15795 @item show history
15796 @itemx show history filename
15797 @itemx show history save
15798 @itemx show history size
15799 @itemx show history expansion
15800 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15801 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15802 @c @end group
15803 @end table
15804
15805 @table @code
15806 @kindex show commands
15807 @cindex show last commands
15808 @cindex display command history
15809 @item show commands
15810 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15811
15812 @item show commands @var{n}
15813 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15814
15815 @item show commands +
15816 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15817 @end table
15818
15819 @node Screen Size
15820 @section Screen size
15821 @cindex size of screen
15822 @cindex pauses in output
15823
15824 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15825 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15826 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15827 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15828 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15829 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15830 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15831 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15832
15833 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15834 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15835 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15836 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15837 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15838 width} commands:
15839
15840 @table @code
15841 @kindex set height
15842 @kindex set width
15843 @kindex show width
15844 @kindex show height
15845 @item set height @var{lpp}
15846 @itemx show height
15847 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15848 @itemx show width
15849 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15850 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15851 commands display the current settings.
15852
15853 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15854 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15855 file or to an editor buffer.
15856
15857 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15858 from wrapping its output.
15859
15860 @item set pagination on
15861 @itemx set pagination off
15862 @kindex set pagination
15863 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15864 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15865
15866 @item show pagination
15867 @kindex show pagination
15868 Show the current pagination mode.
15869 @end table
15870
15871 @node Numbers
15872 @section Numbers
15873 @cindex number representation
15874 @cindex entering numbers
15875
15876 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15877 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15878 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15879 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15880 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15881 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15882 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15883 both input and output with the commands described below.
15884
15885 @table @code
15886 @kindex set input-radix
15887 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15888 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15889 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15890 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15891 example, any of
15892
15893 @smallexample
15894 set input-radix 012
15895 set input-radix 10.
15896 set input-radix 0xa
15897 @end smallexample
15898
15899 @noindent
15900 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15901 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15902 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15903 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15904 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15905 change the radix.
15906
15907 @kindex set output-radix
15908 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15909 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15910 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15911 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15912
15913 @kindex show input-radix
15914 @item show input-radix
15915 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15916
15917 @kindex show output-radix
15918 @item show output-radix
15919 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15920
15921 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15922 @itemx show radix
15923 @kindex set radix
15924 @kindex show radix
15925 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15926 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15927 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15928 default value of 10.
15929
15930 @end table
15931
15932 @node ABI
15933 @section Configuring the current ABI
15934
15935 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15936 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15937 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15938 current ABI.
15939
15940 @cindex OS ABI
15941 @kindex set osabi
15942 @kindex show osabi
15943
15944 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15945 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15946 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15947 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15948 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15949 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15950 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15951 platform provides.
15952
15953 @table @code
15954 @item show osabi
15955 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15956
15957 @item set osabi
15958 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15959
15960 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15961 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15962 @end table
15963
15964 @cindex float promotion
15965
15966 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15967 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15968 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15969 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15970 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15971 @code{double} and then passed.
15972
15973 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15974 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15975 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15976
15977 @table @code
15978 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15979 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15980 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15981 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15982 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15983
15984 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15985 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15986 functions.
15987
15988 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15989 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15990 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15991 @end table
15992
15993 @kindex set cp-abi
15994 @kindex show cp-abi
15995 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15996 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15997 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15998 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15999 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16000 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16001 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16002 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16003 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16004 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16005 ``auto''.
16006
16007 @table @code
16008 @item show cp-abi
16009 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16010
16011 @item set cp-abi
16012 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16013
16014 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16015 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16016 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16017 @end table
16018
16019 @node Messages/Warnings
16020 @section Optional warnings and messages
16021
16022 @cindex verbose operation
16023 @cindex optional warnings
16024 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16025 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16026 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16027 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16028
16029 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16030 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16031 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16032
16033 @table @code
16034 @kindex set verbose
16035 @item set verbose on
16036 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16037
16038 @item set verbose off
16039 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16040
16041 @kindex show verbose
16042 @item show verbose
16043 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16044 @end table
16045
16046 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16047 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16048 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16049 symbol files}).
16050
16051 @table @code
16052
16053 @kindex set complaints
16054 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16055 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16056 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16057 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16058 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16059
16060 @kindex show complaints
16061 @item show complaints
16062 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16063
16064 @end table
16065
16066 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16067 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16068 you try to run a program which is already running:
16069
16070 @smallexample
16071 (@value{GDBP}) run
16072 The program being debugged has been started already.
16073 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16074 @end smallexample
16075
16076 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16077 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16078
16079 @table @code
16080
16081 @kindex set confirm
16082 @cindex flinching
16083 @cindex confirmation
16084 @cindex stupid questions
16085 @item set confirm off
16086 Disables confirmation requests.
16087
16088 @item set confirm on
16089 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16090
16091 @kindex show confirm
16092 @item show confirm
16093 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16094
16095 @end table
16096
16097 @cindex command tracing
16098 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16099 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16100 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16101 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16102
16103 @table @code
16104 @kindex set trace-commands
16105 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16106 @item set trace-commands on
16107 Enable command tracing.
16108 @item set trace-commands off
16109 Disable command tracing.
16110 @item show trace-commands
16111 Display the current state of command tracing.
16112 @end table
16113
16114 @node Debugging Output
16115 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16116 @cindex optional debugging messages
16117
16118 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16119 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16120 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16121 section documents those commands.
16122
16123 @table @code
16124 @kindex set exec-done-display
16125 @item set exec-done-display
16126 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16127 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16128 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16129 @kindex show exec-done-display
16130 @item show exec-done-display
16131 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16132 notification.
16133 @kindex set debug
16134 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16135 @cindex architecture debugging info
16136 @item set debug arch
16137 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16138 @kindex show debug
16139 @item show debug arch
16140 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16141 @item set debug aix-thread
16142 @cindex AIX threads
16143 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16144 module.
16145 @item show debug aix-thread
16146 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16147 @item set debug event
16148 @cindex event debugging info
16149 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16150 default is off.
16151 @item show debug event
16152 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16153 info.
16154 @item set debug expression
16155 @cindex expression debugging info
16156 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16157 expression parsing. The default is off.
16158 @item show debug expression
16159 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16160 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16161 @item set debug frame
16162 @cindex frame debugging info
16163 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16164 default is off.
16165 @item show debug frame
16166 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16167 info.
16168 @item set debug infrun
16169 @cindex inferior debugging info
16170 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16171 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16172 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16173 @item show debug infrun
16174 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16175 @item set debug lin-lwp
16176 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16177 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16178 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16179 @item show debug lin-lwp
16180 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16181 @item set debug observer
16182 @cindex observer debugging info
16183 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16184 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16185 @item show debug observer
16186 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16187 @item set debug overload
16188 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16189 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16190 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16191 is off.
16192 @item show debug overload
16193 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16194 debugging info.
16195 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16196 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16197 @cindex debug remote protocol
16198 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16199 @cindex display remote packets
16200 @item set debug remote
16201 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16202 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16203 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16204 @item show debug remote
16205 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16206 @item set debug serial
16207 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16208 default is off.
16209 @item show debug serial
16210 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16211 info.
16212 @item set debug solib-frv
16213 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16214 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16215 @item show debug solib-frv
16216 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16217 messages.
16218 @item set debug target
16219 @cindex target debugging info
16220 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16221 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16222 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16223 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16224 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16225 @item show debug target
16226 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16227 info.
16228 @item set debugvarobj
16229 @cindex variable object debugging info
16230 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16231 info. The default is off.
16232 @item show debugvarobj
16233 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16234 debugging info.
16235 @end table
16236
16237 @node Sequences
16238 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16239
16240 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16241 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16242 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16243 files.
16244
16245 @menu
16246 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16247 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16248 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16249 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16250 @end menu
16251
16252 @node Define
16253 @section User-defined commands
16254
16255 @cindex user-defined command
16256 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16257 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16258 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16259 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16260 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16261 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16262
16263 @smallexample
16264 define adder
16265 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16266 end
16267 @end smallexample
16268
16269 @noindent
16270 To execute the command use:
16271
16272 @smallexample
16273 adder 1 2 3
16274 @end smallexample
16275
16276 @noindent
16277 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16278 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16279 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16280 functions calls.
16281
16282 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16283 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16284 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16285 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16286
16287 @smallexample
16288 define adder
16289 if $argc == 2
16290 print $arg0 + $arg1
16291 end
16292 if $argc == 3
16293 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16294 end
16295 end
16296 @end smallexample
16297
16298 @table @code
16299
16300 @kindex define
16301 @item define @var{commandname}
16302 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16303 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16304
16305 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16306 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16307 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16308
16309 @kindex document
16310 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16311 @item document @var{commandname}
16312 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16313 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16314 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16315 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16316 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16317 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16318
16319 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16320 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16321 does not change the documentation.
16322
16323 @kindex dont-repeat
16324 @cindex don't repeat command
16325 @item dont-repeat
16326 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16327 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16328 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16329
16330 @kindex help user-defined
16331 @item help user-defined
16332 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16333 (if any) for each.
16334
16335 @kindex show user
16336 @item show user
16337 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16338 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16339 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16340 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16341
16342 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16343 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16344 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16345 @item show max-user-call-depth
16346 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16347 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16348 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16349 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16350 @end table
16351
16352 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16353 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16354
16355 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16356 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16357 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16358
16359 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16360 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16361 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16362 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16363
16364 @node Hooks
16365 @section User-defined command hooks
16366 @cindex command hooks
16367 @cindex hooks, for commands
16368 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16369
16370 @kindex hook
16371 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16372 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16373 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16374 before that command.
16375
16376 @cindex hooks, post-command
16377 @kindex hookpost
16378 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16379 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16380 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16381 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16382 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16383
16384 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16385 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16386
16387 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16388 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16389
16390 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16391 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16392 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16393 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16394 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16395
16396 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16397 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16398 you could define:
16399
16400 @smallexample
16401 define hook-stop
16402 handle SIGALRM nopass
16403 end
16404
16405 define hook-run
16406 handle SIGALRM pass
16407 end
16408
16409 define hook-continue
16410 handle SIGLARM pass
16411 end
16412 @end smallexample
16413
16414 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16415 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16416 you could define:
16417
16418 @smallexample
16419 define hook-echo
16420 echo <<<---
16421 end
16422
16423 define hookpost-echo
16424 echo --->>>\n
16425 end
16426
16427 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16428 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16429 (@value{GDBP})
16430
16431 @end smallexample
16432
16433 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16434 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16435 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16436 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16437 @c or not?
16438 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16439 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16440 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16441
16442 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16443 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16444
16445 @node Command Files
16446 @section Command files
16447
16448 @cindex command files
16449 @cindex scripting commands
16450 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16451 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16452 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16453 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16454 terminal.
16455
16456 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16457 command:
16458
16459 @table @code
16460 @kindex source
16461 @cindex execute commands from a file
16462 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16463 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16464 @end table
16465
16466 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16467 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16468 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16469 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16470 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16471
16472 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16473 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16474
16475 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16476 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16477 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16478
16479 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16480 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16481 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16482 when called from command files.
16483
16484 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16485 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16486 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16487 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16488 the next command.
16489
16490 @smallexample
16491 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16495 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16496 would be directed to @file{log}.
16497
16498 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16499 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16500 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16501 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16502 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16503 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16504 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16505 conditionally, etc.
16506
16507 @table @code
16508 @kindex if
16509 @kindex else
16510 @item if
16511 @itemx else
16512 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16513 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16514 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16515 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16516 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16517 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16518 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16519
16520 @kindex while
16521 @item while
16522 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16523 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16524 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16525 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16526 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16527 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16528
16529 @kindex loop_break
16530 @item loop_break
16531 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16532 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16533 line.
16534
16535 @kindex loop_continue
16536 @item loop_continue
16537 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16538 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16539 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16540 the controlling expression.
16541
16542 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16543 @item end
16544 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16545 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16546 @end table
16547
16548
16549 @node Output
16550 @section Commands for controlled output
16551
16552 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16553 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16554 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16555 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16556 want.
16557
16558 @table @code
16559 @kindex echo
16560 @item echo @var{text}
16561 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16562 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16563 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16564 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16565 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16566 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16567 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16568 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16569 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16570 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16571 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16572
16573 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16574 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16575
16576 @smallexample
16577 echo This is some text\n\
16578 which is continued\n\
16579 onto several lines.\n
16580 @end smallexample
16581
16582 produces the same output as
16583
16584 @smallexample
16585 echo This is some text\n
16586 echo which is continued\n
16587 echo onto several lines.\n
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590 @kindex output
16591 @item output @var{expression}
16592 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16593 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16594 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16595 on expressions.
16596
16597 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16598 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16599 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16600 formats}, for more information.
16601
16602 @kindex printf
16603 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16604 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16605 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16606 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16607 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16608 subroutine
16609 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16610 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16611 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16612 @c supported.
16613
16614 @smallexample
16615 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16616 @end smallexample
16617
16618 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16619
16620 @smallexample
16621 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16622 @end smallexample
16623
16624 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16625 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16626 letter.
16627 @end table
16628
16629 @node Interpreters
16630 @chapter Command Interpreters
16631 @cindex command interpreters
16632
16633 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16634 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16635 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16636
16637 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16638 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16639 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16640 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16641
16642 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16643 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16644 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16645 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16646
16647 @table @code
16648 @item console
16649 @cindex console interpreter
16650 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16651 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16652 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16653
16654 @item mi
16655 @cindex mi interpreter
16656 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16657 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16658 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16659 Interface}.
16660
16661 @item mi2
16662 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16663 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16664
16665 @item mi1
16666 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16667 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16668
16669 @end table
16670
16671 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16672 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16673 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16674 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16675 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16676 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16677 the IDE inoperable!
16678
16679 @kindex interpreter-exec
16680 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16681 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16682 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16683 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16684
16685 @smallexample
16686 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16687 @end smallexample
16688
16689 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16690 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16691
16692 @node TUI
16693 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16694 @cindex TUI
16695 @cindex Text User Interface
16696
16697 @menu
16698 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16699 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16700 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16701 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16702 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16703 @end menu
16704
16705 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16706 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16707 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16708 commands in separate text windows.
16709
16710 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16711 @pindex gdbtui
16712 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16713
16714 @node TUI Overview
16715 @section TUI overview
16716
16717 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16718 @value{GDBN} runs:
16719
16720 @itemize @bullet
16721 @item
16722 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16723 windows on the terminal.
16724
16725 @item
16726 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16727 the TUI.
16728 @end itemize
16729
16730 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16731 on the terminal:
16732
16733 @table @emph
16734 @item command
16735 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16736 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16737 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16738 window is always visible.
16739
16740 @item source
16741 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16742 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16743
16744 @item assembly
16745 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16746
16747 @item register
16748 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16749 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16750 changed are highlighted.
16751
16752 @end table
16753
16754 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16755 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16756 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16757 indicates the breakpoint type:
16758
16759 @table @code
16760 @item B
16761 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16762
16763 @item b
16764 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16765
16766 @item H
16767 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16768
16769 @item h
16770 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16771
16772 @end table
16773
16774 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16775
16776 @table @code
16777 @item +
16778 Breakpoint is enabled.
16779
16780 @item -
16781 Breakpoint is disabled.
16782
16783 @end table
16784
16785 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16786 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16787 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16788 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16789 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16790 The following layouts are available:
16791
16792 @itemize @bullet
16793 @item
16794 source
16795
16796 @item
16797 assembly
16798
16799 @item
16800 source and assembly
16801
16802 @item
16803 source and registers
16804
16805 @item
16806 assembly and registers
16807
16808 @end itemize
16809
16810 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16811 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16812 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16813 are displayed:
16814
16815 @table @emph
16816 @item target
16817 Indicates the current gdb target
16818 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16819
16820 @item process
16821 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16822 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16823
16824 @item function
16825 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16826 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16827 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16828 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16829
16830 @item line
16831 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16832 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16833
16834 @item pc
16835 Indicates the current program counter address.
16836
16837 @end table
16838
16839 @node TUI Keys
16840 @section TUI Key Bindings
16841 @cindex TUI key bindings
16842
16843 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16844 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16845 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16846 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16847 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16848 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16849 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16850
16851 @table @kbd
16852 @kindex C-x C-a
16853 @item C-x C-a
16854 @kindex C-x a
16855 @itemx C-x a
16856 @kindex C-x A
16857 @itemx C-x A
16858 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16859 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16860 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16861 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16862 The screen is then refreshed.
16863
16864 @kindex C-x 1
16865 @item C-x 1
16866 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16867 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16868 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16869
16870 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16871
16872 @kindex C-x 2
16873 @item C-x 2
16874 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16875 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16876 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16877 previous layout and the new one.
16878
16879 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16880
16881 @kindex C-x o
16882 @item C-x o
16883 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16884 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16885 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16886
16887 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16888
16889 @kindex C-x s
16890 @item C-x s
16891 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16892 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16893
16894 @end table
16895
16896 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16897
16898 @table @key
16899 @kindex PgUp
16900 @item PgUp
16901 Scroll the active window one page up.
16902
16903 @kindex PgDn
16904 @item PgDn
16905 Scroll the active window one page down.
16906
16907 @kindex Up
16908 @item Up
16909 Scroll the active window one line up.
16910
16911 @kindex Down
16912 @item Down
16913 Scroll the active window one line down.
16914
16915 @kindex Left
16916 @item Left
16917 Scroll the active window one column left.
16918
16919 @kindex Right
16920 @item Right
16921 Scroll the active window one column right.
16922
16923 @kindex C-L
16924 @item C-L
16925 Refresh the screen.
16926
16927 @end table
16928
16929 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16930 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16931 active window is the command window. When the command window
16932 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16933 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
16934
16935 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16936 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16937 @cindex TUI single key mode
16938
16939 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16940 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16941 some gdb commands.
16942
16943 @table @kbd
16944 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16945 @item c
16946 continue
16947
16948 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16949 @item d
16950 down
16951
16952 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16953 @item f
16954 finish
16955
16956 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16957 @item n
16958 next
16959
16960 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16961 @item q
16962 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16963
16964 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16965 @item r
16966 run
16967
16968 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16969 @item s
16970 step
16971
16972 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16973 @item u
16974 up
16975
16976 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16977 @item v
16978 info locals
16979
16980 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16981 @item w
16982 where
16983
16984 @end table
16985
16986 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16987 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16988 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16989 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16990 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16991 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16992
16993
16994 @node TUI Commands
16995 @section TUI specific commands
16996 @cindex TUI commands
16997
16998 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16999 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17000 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17001 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17002 in the TUI mode.
17003
17004 @table @code
17005 @item info win
17006 @kindex info win
17007 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17008
17009 @item layout next
17010 @kindex layout
17011 Display the next layout.
17012
17013 @item layout prev
17014 Display the previous layout.
17015
17016 @item layout src
17017 Display the source window only.
17018
17019 @item layout asm
17020 Display the assembly window only.
17021
17022 @item layout split
17023 Display the source and assembly window.
17024
17025 @item layout regs
17026 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17027
17028 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17029 @kindex focus
17030 Set the focus to the named window.
17031 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17032 can be affected to another window.
17033
17034 @item refresh
17035 @kindex refresh
17036 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17037
17038 @item tui reg float
17039 @kindex tui reg
17040 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17041
17042 @item tui reg general
17043 Show the general registers in the register window.
17044
17045 @item tui reg next
17046 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17047 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17048 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17049 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17050
17051 @item tui reg system
17052 Show the system registers in the register window.
17053
17054 @item update
17055 @kindex update
17056 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17057
17058 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17059 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17060 @kindex winheight
17061 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17062 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17063 decrease it.
17064
17065 @item tabset
17066 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17067 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17068
17069 @end table
17070
17071 @node TUI Configuration
17072 @section TUI configuration variables
17073 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17074
17075 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17076 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17077
17078 @table @code
17079 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17080 @kindex set tui border-kind
17081 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17082 The possible values are the following:
17083 @table @code
17084 @item space
17085 Use a space character to draw the border.
17086
17087 @item ascii
17088 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17089
17090 @item acs
17091 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17092 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17093
17094 @end table
17095
17096 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17097 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17098 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17099 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17100 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17101
17102 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17103 @kindex set tui border-mode
17104 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17105 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17106 @table @code
17107 @item normal
17108 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17109
17110 @item standout
17111 Use standout mode.
17112
17113 @item reverse
17114 Use reverse video mode.
17115
17116 @item half
17117 Use half bright mode.
17118
17119 @item half-standout
17120 Use half bright and standout mode.
17121
17122 @item bold
17123 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17124
17125 @item bold-standout
17126 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17127
17128 @end table
17129
17130 @end table
17131
17132 @node Emacs
17133 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17134
17135 @cindex Emacs
17136 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17137 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17138 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17139 @value{GDBN}.
17140
17141 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17142 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17143 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17144 created Emacs buffer.
17145 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17146
17147 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17148 things:
17149
17150 @itemize @bullet
17151 @item
17152 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17153 @end itemize
17154
17155 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17156 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17157
17158 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17159 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17160 in this way.
17161
17162 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17163 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17164 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17165 stop.
17166
17167 @itemize @bullet
17168 @item
17169 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17170 @end itemize
17171
17172 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17173 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17174 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17175 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17176 and the source.
17177
17178 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17179 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17180
17181 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17182 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17183 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17184 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17185 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17186 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17187 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17188 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17189 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17190
17191 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17192 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17193 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17194 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17195
17196 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17197 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17198 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17199 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17200 one you want.
17201
17202 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17203 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17204
17205 @table @kbd
17206 @item C-h m
17207 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17208
17209 @item C-c C-s
17210 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17211 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17212
17213 @item C-c C-n
17214 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17215 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17216 to show the current file and location.
17217
17218 @item C-c C-i
17219 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17220 display window accordingly.
17221
17222 @item C-c C-f
17223 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17224 @code{finish} command.
17225
17226 @item C-c C-r
17227 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17228 command.
17229
17230 @item C-c <
17231 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17232 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17233 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17234
17235 @item C-c >
17236 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17237 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17238 @end table
17239
17240 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17241 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17242
17243 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17244 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17245 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17246 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17247 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17248 current one.
17249
17250 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17251 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17252 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17253 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17254 frame.
17255
17256 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17257 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17258 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17259 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17260 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17261 to correspond properly with the code.
17262
17263 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17264 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17265 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17266
17267 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17268 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17269 @ignore
17270 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17271 @kindex Epoch
17272 @kindex inspect
17273
17274 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17275 called the @code{epoch}
17276 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17277 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17278 each value is printed in its own window.
17279 @end ignore
17280
17281
17282 @node GDB/MI
17283 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17284
17285 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17286
17287 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17288 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17289 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17290 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17291 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17292 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17293
17294 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17295 in the form of a reference manual.
17296
17297 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17298 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17299 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17300
17301 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17302
17303 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17304 This chapter uses the following notation:
17305
17306 @itemize @bullet
17307 @item
17308 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17309
17310 @item
17311 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17312 it may or may not be given.
17313
17314 @item
17315 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17316 may repeat zero or more times.
17317
17318 @item
17319 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17320 may repeat one or more times.
17321
17322 @item
17323 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17324 @end itemize
17325
17326 @ignore
17327 @heading Dependencies
17328 @end ignore
17329
17330 @menu
17331 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17332 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17333 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17334 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17335 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17336 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17337 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17338 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17339 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17340 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17341 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17342 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17343 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17344 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17345 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17346 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17347 @ignore
17348 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17349 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17350 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17351 @end ignore
17352 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17353 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17354 @end menu
17355
17356 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17357 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17358 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17359
17360 @menu
17361 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17362 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17363 @end menu
17364
17365 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17366 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17367
17368 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17369 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17370 @table @code
17371 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17372 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17373
17374 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17375 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17376 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17377
17378 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17379 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17380 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17381
17382 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17383 "any sequence of digits"
17384
17385 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17386 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17387
17388 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17389 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17390
17391 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17392 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17393
17394 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17395 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17396 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17397
17398 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17399 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17400
17401 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17402 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17403 @end table
17404
17405 @noindent
17406 Notes:
17407
17408 @itemize @bullet
17409 @item
17410 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17411 output is described below.
17412
17413 @item
17414 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17415 finishes.
17416
17417 @item
17418 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17419 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17420 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17421 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17422 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17423 @end itemize
17424
17425 Pragmatics:
17426
17427 @itemize @bullet
17428 @item
17429 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17430
17431 @item
17432 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17433 @end itemize
17434
17435 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17436 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17437
17438 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17439 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17440 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17441 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17442 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17443 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17444
17445 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17446 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17447 @var{token}.
17448
17449 @table @code
17450 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17451 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17452
17453 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17454 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17455
17456 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17457 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17458
17459 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17460 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17461
17462 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17463 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17464
17465 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17466 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17467
17468 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17469 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17470
17471 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17472 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17473
17474 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17475 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17476
17477 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17478 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17479 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17480
17481 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17482 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17483
17484 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17485 @code{ @var{string} }
17486
17487 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17488 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17489
17490 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17491 @code{@var{c-string}}
17492
17493 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17494 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17495
17496 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17497 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17498 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17499
17500 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17501 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17502
17503 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17504 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17505
17506 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17507 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17508
17509 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17510 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17511
17512 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17513 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17514
17515 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17516 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17517 @end table
17518
17519 @noindent
17520 Notes:
17521
17522 @itemize @bullet
17523 @item
17524 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17525
17526 @item
17527 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17528 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17529 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17530 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17531
17532 @item
17533 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17534 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17535 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17536 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17537
17538 @item
17539 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17540 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17541 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17542 @samp{*}.
17543
17544 @item
17545 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17546 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17547 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17548 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17549
17550 @item
17551 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17552 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17553 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17554 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17555
17556 @item
17557 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17558 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17559 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17560
17561 @item
17562 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17563 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17564 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17565 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17566
17567 @item
17568 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17569 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17570 @var{values}.
17571
17572
17573 @end itemize
17574
17575 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17576 details about the various output records.
17577
17578 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17579 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17580 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17581
17582 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17583 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17584
17585 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17586 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17587 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17588 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17589 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17590 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17591
17592 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17593 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17594 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17595
17596 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17597 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17598 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17599 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17600
17601 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17602 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17603
17604 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17605 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17606 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17607 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17608 might change.
17609
17610 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17611 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17612 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17613 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17614
17615 @itemize @bullet
17616 @item
17617 New MI commands may be added.
17618
17619 @item
17620 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17621
17622 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17623 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17624
17625 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17626 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17627 @end itemize
17628
17629 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17630 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17631 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17632 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17633 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17634
17635 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17636 @c version?
17637
17638 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17639 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17640 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17641 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17642 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17643 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17644 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17645 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17646 @cindex mailing lists
17647
17648 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17649 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17650 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17651
17652 @menu
17653 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17654 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17655 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17656 @end menu
17657
17658 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17659 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17660
17661 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17662 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17663 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17664 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17665
17666 @table @code
17667 @findex ^done
17668 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17669 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17670 values.
17671
17672 @item "^running"
17673 @findex ^running
17674 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17675 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17676 running.
17677
17678 @item "^connected"
17679 @findex ^connected
17680 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17681
17682 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17683 @findex ^error
17684 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17685 error message.
17686
17687 @item "^exit"
17688 @findex ^exit
17689 GDB has terminated.
17690
17691 @end table
17692
17693 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17694 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17695
17696 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17697 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17698 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17699 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17700 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17701
17702 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17703 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17704 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17705 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17706 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17707
17708 @table @code
17709 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17710 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17711 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17712
17713 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17714 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17715 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17716 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17717
17718 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17719 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17720 internals.
17721 @end table
17722
17723 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17724 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17725
17726 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17727 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17728 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17729 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17730 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17731 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17732
17733 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17734 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17735
17736 @table @code
17737 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17738 @end table
17739
17740 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17741
17742 @table @code
17743 @item breakpoint-hit
17744 A breakpoint was reached.
17745 @item watchpoint-trigger
17746 A watchpoint was triggered.
17747 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17748 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17749 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17750 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17751 @item function-finished
17752 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17753 @item location-reached
17754 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17755 @item watchpoint-scope
17756 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17757 @item end-stepping-range
17758 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17759 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17760 @item exited-signalled
17761 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17762 @item exited
17763 The inferior exited.
17764 @item exited-normally
17765 The inferior exited normally.
17766 @item signal-received
17767 A signal was received by the inferior.
17768 @end table
17769
17770
17771 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17772 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17773 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17774 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17775
17776 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17777 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17778 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17779 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17780
17781 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17782 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17783
17784 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17785
17786 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17787 information of the breakpoint.
17788
17789 @smallexample
17790 -> -break-insert main
17791 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17792 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17793 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17794 <- (gdb)
17795 @end smallexample
17796
17797 @subheading Program Execution
17798
17799 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17800 reason that execution stopped.
17801
17802 @smallexample
17803 -> -exec-run
17804 <- ^running
17805 <- (gdb)
17806 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17807 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17808 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17809 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17810 <- (gdb)
17811 -> -exec-continue
17812 <- ^running
17813 <- (gdb)
17814 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17815 <- (gdb)
17816 @end smallexample
17817
17818 @subheading Quitting GDB
17819
17820 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 -> (gdb)
17824 <- -gdb-exit
17825 <- ^exit
17826 @end smallexample
17827
17828 @subheading A Bad Command
17829
17830 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17831
17832 @smallexample
17833 -> -rubbish
17834 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17835 <- (gdb)
17836 @end smallexample
17837
17838
17839 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17840 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17841 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17842
17843 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17844 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17845
17846 @subheading Motivation
17847
17848 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17849
17850 @subheading Introduction
17851
17852 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17853
17854 @subheading Commands
17855
17856 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17857
17858 @subsubheading Synopsis
17859
17860 @smallexample
17861 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17862 @end smallexample
17863
17864 @subsubheading Result
17865
17866 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17867
17868 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17869
17870 @subsubheading Example
17871
17872 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17873 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17874
17875
17876 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17877 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17878 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17879
17880 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17881 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17882 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17883 breakpoints.
17884
17885 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17886 @findex -break-after
17887
17888 @subsubheading Synopsis
17889
17890 @smallexample
17891 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17892 @end smallexample
17893
17894 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17895 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17896 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17897 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17898
17899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17900
17901 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17902
17903 @subsubheading Example
17904
17905 @smallexample
17906 (gdb)
17907 -break-insert main
17908 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17909 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17910 (gdb)
17911 -break-after 1 3
17912 ~
17913 ^done
17914 (gdb)
17915 -break-list
17916 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17917 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17918 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17919 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17920 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17921 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17922 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17923 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17924 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17925 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17926 (gdb)
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 @ignore
17930 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17931 @findex -break-catch
17932
17933 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17934 @findex -break-commands
17935 @end ignore
17936
17937
17938 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17939 @findex -break-condition
17940
17941 @subsubheading Synopsis
17942
17943 @smallexample
17944 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17945 @end smallexample
17946
17947 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17948 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17949 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17950 command below).
17951
17952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17953
17954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17955
17956 @subsubheading Example
17957
17958 @smallexample
17959 (gdb)
17960 -break-condition 1 1
17961 ^done
17962 (gdb)
17963 -break-list
17964 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17965 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17966 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17967 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17968 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17969 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17970 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17971 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17972 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17973 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17974 (gdb)
17975 @end smallexample
17976
17977 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17978 @findex -break-delete
17979
17980 @subsubheading Synopsis
17981
17982 @smallexample
17983 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17984 @end smallexample
17985
17986 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17987 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17988
17989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17990
17991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17992
17993 @subsubheading Example
17994
17995 @smallexample
17996 (gdb)
17997 -break-delete 1
17998 ^done
17999 (gdb)
18000 -break-list
18001 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18002 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18003 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18004 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18005 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18006 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18007 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18008 body=[]@}
18009 (gdb)
18010 @end smallexample
18011
18012 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18013 @findex -break-disable
18014
18015 @subsubheading Synopsis
18016
18017 @smallexample
18018 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18019 @end smallexample
18020
18021 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18022 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18023
18024 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18025
18026 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18027
18028 @subsubheading Example
18029
18030 @smallexample
18031 (gdb)
18032 -break-disable 2
18033 ^done
18034 (gdb)
18035 -break-list
18036 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18037 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18038 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18039 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18040 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18041 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18042 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18043 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18044 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18045 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18046 (gdb)
18047 @end smallexample
18048
18049 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18050 @findex -break-enable
18051
18052 @subsubheading Synopsis
18053
18054 @smallexample
18055 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18056 @end smallexample
18057
18058 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18059
18060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18061
18062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18063
18064 @subsubheading Example
18065
18066 @smallexample
18067 (gdb)
18068 -break-enable 2
18069 ^done
18070 (gdb)
18071 -break-list
18072 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18073 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18074 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18075 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18076 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18077 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18078 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18079 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18080 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18081 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18082 (gdb)
18083 @end smallexample
18084
18085 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18086 @findex -break-info
18087
18088 @subsubheading Synopsis
18089
18090 @smallexample
18091 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18092 @end smallexample
18093
18094 @c REDUNDANT???
18095 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18096
18097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18098
18099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18100
18101 @subsubheading Example
18102 N.A.
18103
18104 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18105 @findex -break-insert
18106
18107 @subsubheading Synopsis
18108
18109 @smallexample
18110 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18111 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18112 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18113 @end smallexample
18114
18115 @noindent
18116 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18117
18118 @itemize @bullet
18119 @item function
18120 @c @item +offset
18121 @c @item -offset
18122 @c @item linenum
18123 @item filename:linenum
18124 @item filename:function
18125 @item *address
18126 @end itemize
18127
18128 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18129
18130 @table @samp
18131 @item -t
18132 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18133 @item -h
18134 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18135 @item -c @var{condition}
18136 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18137 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18138 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18139 @item -r
18140 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18141 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18142 expresson.
18143 @end table
18144
18145 @subsubheading Result
18146
18147 The result is in the form:
18148
18149 @smallexample
18150 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18151 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18152 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18153 times="@var{times}"@}
18154 @end smallexample
18155
18156 @noindent
18157 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18158 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18159 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18160 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18161 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18162 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18163 which use the same output).
18164
18165 Note: this format is open to change.
18166 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18167
18168 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18169
18170 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18171 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18172
18173 @subsubheading Example
18174
18175 @smallexample
18176 (gdb)
18177 -break-insert main
18178 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18179 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18180 (gdb)
18181 -break-insert -t foo
18182 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18183 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18184 (gdb)
18185 -break-list
18186 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18187 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18188 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18189 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18190 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18191 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18192 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18193 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18194 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18195 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18196 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18197 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18198 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18199 (gdb)
18200 -break-insert -r foo.*
18201 ~int foo(int, int);
18202 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18203 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18204 (gdb)
18205 @end smallexample
18206
18207 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18208 @findex -break-list
18209
18210 @subsubheading Synopsis
18211
18212 @smallexample
18213 -break-list
18214 @end smallexample
18215
18216 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18217
18218 @table @samp
18219 @item Number
18220 number of the breakpoint
18221 @item Type
18222 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18223 @item Disposition
18224 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18225 or @samp{nokeep}
18226 @item Enabled
18227 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18228 @item Address
18229 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18230 @item What
18231 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18232 name, line number
18233 @item Times
18234 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18235 @end table
18236
18237 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18238 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18239
18240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18241
18242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18243
18244 @subsubheading Example
18245
18246 @smallexample
18247 (gdb)
18248 -break-list
18249 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18250 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18251 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18252 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18253 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18254 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18255 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18256 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18257 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18258 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18259 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18260 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18261 (gdb)
18262 @end smallexample
18263
18264 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18265
18266 @smallexample
18267 (gdb)
18268 -break-list
18269 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18270 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18271 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18272 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18273 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18274 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18275 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18276 body=[]@}
18277 (gdb)
18278 @end smallexample
18279
18280 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18281 @findex -break-watch
18282
18283 @subsubheading Synopsis
18284
18285 @smallexample
18286 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18287 @end smallexample
18288
18289 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18290 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18291 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18292 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18293 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18294 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18295 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18296 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18297
18298 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18299 breakpoints inserted.
18300
18301 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18302
18303 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18304 @samp{rwatch}.
18305
18306 @subsubheading Example
18307
18308 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18309
18310 @smallexample
18311 (gdb)
18312 -break-watch x
18313 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18314 (gdb)
18315 -exec-continue
18316 ^running
18317 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18318 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18319 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18320 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18321 (gdb)
18322 @end smallexample
18323
18324 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18325 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18326 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18327
18328 @smallexample
18329 (gdb)
18330 -break-watch C
18331 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18332 (gdb)
18333 -exec-continue
18334 ^running
18335 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18336 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18337 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18338 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18339 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18340 (gdb)
18341 -exec-continue
18342 ^running
18343 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18344 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18345 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18346 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18347 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18348 (gdb)
18349 @end smallexample
18350
18351 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18352 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18353 deleted.
18354
18355 @smallexample
18356 (gdb)
18357 -break-watch C
18358 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18359 (gdb)
18360 -break-list
18361 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18362 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18363 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18364 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18365 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18366 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18367 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18368 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18369 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18370 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18371 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18372 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18373 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18374 (gdb)
18375 -exec-continue
18376 ^running
18377 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18378 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18379 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18380 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18381 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18382 (gdb)
18383 -break-list
18384 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18385 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18386 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18387 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18388 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18389 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18390 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18391 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18392 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18393 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18394 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18395 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18396 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18397 (gdb)
18398 -exec-continue
18399 ^running
18400 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18401 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18402 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18403 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18404 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18405 (gdb)
18406 -break-list
18407 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18408 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18409 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18410 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18411 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18412 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18413 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18414 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18415 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18416 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18417 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18418 times="1"@}]@}
18419 (gdb)
18420 @end smallexample
18421
18422 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18423 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18424 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18425
18426 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18427 @findex -exec-arguments
18428
18429
18430 @subsubheading Synopsis
18431
18432 @smallexample
18433 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18434 @end smallexample
18435
18436 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18437 @samp{-exec-run}.
18438
18439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18440
18441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18442
18443 @subsubheading Example
18444
18445 @c FIXME!
18446 Don't have one around.
18447
18448
18449 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18450 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18451
18452 @subsubheading Synopsis
18453
18454 @smallexample
18455 -exec-show-arguments
18456 @end smallexample
18457
18458 Print the arguments of the program.
18459
18460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18461
18462 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18463
18464 @subsubheading Example
18465 N.A.
18466
18467
18468 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18469 @findex -environment-cd
18470
18471 @subsubheading Synopsis
18472
18473 @smallexample
18474 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18475 @end smallexample
18476
18477 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18478
18479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18480
18481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18482
18483 @subsubheading Example
18484
18485 @smallexample
18486 (gdb)
18487 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18488 ^done
18489 (gdb)
18490 @end smallexample
18491
18492
18493 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18494 @findex -environment-directory
18495
18496 @subsubheading Synopsis
18497
18498 @smallexample
18499 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18500 @end smallexample
18501
18502 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18503 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18504 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18505 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18506 occurs as normal.
18507 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18508 multiple directories in a single command
18509 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18510 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18511 If blanks are needed as
18512 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18513 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18514 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18515 character must not be used
18516 in any directory name.
18517 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18518
18519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18520
18521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18522
18523 @subsubheading Example
18524
18525 @smallexample
18526 (gdb)
18527 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18528 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18529 (gdb)
18530 -environment-directory ""
18531 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18532 (gdb)
18533 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18534 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18535 (gdb)
18536 -environment-directory -r
18537 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18538 (gdb)
18539 @end smallexample
18540
18541
18542 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18543 @findex -environment-path
18544
18545 @subsubheading Synopsis
18546
18547 @smallexample
18548 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18549 @end smallexample
18550
18551 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18552 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18553 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18554 supplied in addition to the
18555 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18556 occurs as normal.
18557 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18558 multiple directories in a single command
18559 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18560 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18561 If blanks are needed as
18562 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18563 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18564 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18565 character must not be used
18566 in any directory name.
18567 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18568
18569
18570 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18571
18572 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18573
18574 @subsubheading Example
18575
18576 @smallexample
18577 (gdb)
18578 -environment-path
18579 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18580 (gdb)
18581 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18582 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18583 (gdb)
18584 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18585 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18586 (gdb)
18587 @end smallexample
18588
18589
18590 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18591 @findex -environment-pwd
18592
18593 @subsubheading Synopsis
18594
18595 @smallexample
18596 -environment-pwd
18597 @end smallexample
18598
18599 Show the current working directory.
18600
18601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18602
18603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18604
18605 @subsubheading Example
18606
18607 @smallexample
18608 (gdb)
18609 -environment-pwd
18610 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18611 (gdb)
18612 @end smallexample
18613
18614 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18615 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18616 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18617
18618
18619 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18620 @findex -thread-info
18621
18622 @subsubheading Synopsis
18623
18624 @smallexample
18625 -thread-info
18626 @end smallexample
18627
18628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18629
18630 No equivalent.
18631
18632 @subsubheading Example
18633 N.A.
18634
18635
18636 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18637 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18638
18639 @subsubheading Synopsis
18640
18641 @smallexample
18642 -thread-list-all-threads
18643 @end smallexample
18644
18645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18646
18647 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18648
18649 @subsubheading Example
18650 N.A.
18651
18652
18653 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18654 @findex -thread-list-ids
18655
18656 @subsubheading Synopsis
18657
18658 @smallexample
18659 -thread-list-ids
18660 @end smallexample
18661
18662 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18663 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18664
18665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18666
18667 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18668
18669 @subsubheading Example
18670
18671 No threads present, besides the main process:
18672
18673 @smallexample
18674 (gdb)
18675 -thread-list-ids
18676 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18677 (gdb)
18678 @end smallexample
18679
18680
18681 Several threads:
18682
18683 @smallexample
18684 (gdb)
18685 -thread-list-ids
18686 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18687 number-of-threads="3"
18688 (gdb)
18689 @end smallexample
18690
18691
18692 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18693 @findex -thread-select
18694
18695 @subsubheading Synopsis
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18699 @end smallexample
18700
18701 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18702 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18703
18704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18705
18706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18707
18708 @subsubheading Example
18709
18710 @smallexample
18711 (gdb)
18712 -exec-next
18713 ^running
18714 (gdb)
18715 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18716 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18717 (gdb)
18718 -thread-list-ids
18719 ^done,
18720 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18721 number-of-threads="3"
18722 (gdb)
18723 -thread-select 3
18724 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18725 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18726 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18727 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18728 (gdb)
18729 @end smallexample
18730
18731 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18732 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18733 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18734
18735 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18736 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18737 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18738 other cases.
18739
18740 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18741 @findex -exec-continue
18742
18743 @subsubheading Synopsis
18744
18745 @smallexample
18746 -exec-continue
18747 @end smallexample
18748
18749 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18750 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18751
18752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18753
18754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18755
18756 @subsubheading Example
18757
18758 @smallexample
18759 -exec-continue
18760 ^running
18761 (gdb)
18762 @@Hello world
18763 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18764 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18765 (gdb)
18766 @end smallexample
18767
18768
18769 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18770 @findex -exec-finish
18771
18772 @subsubheading Synopsis
18773
18774 @smallexample
18775 -exec-finish
18776 @end smallexample
18777
18778 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18779 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18780
18781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18782
18783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18784
18785 @subsubheading Example
18786
18787 Function returning @code{void}.
18788
18789 @smallexample
18790 -exec-finish
18791 ^running
18792 (gdb)
18793 @@hello from foo
18794 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18795 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18796 (gdb)
18797 @end smallexample
18798
18799 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18800 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18801 value itself.
18802
18803 @smallexample
18804 -exec-finish
18805 ^running
18806 (gdb)
18807 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18808 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18809 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18810 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18811 (gdb)
18812 @end smallexample
18813
18814
18815 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18816 @findex -exec-interrupt
18817
18818 @subsubheading Synopsis
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 -exec-interrupt
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18825 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18826 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18827 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18828 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18829
18830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18831
18832 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18833
18834 @subsubheading Example
18835
18836 @smallexample
18837 (gdb)
18838 111-exec-continue
18839 111^running
18840
18841 (gdb)
18842 222-exec-interrupt
18843 222^done
18844 (gdb)
18845 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18846 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18847 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18848 (gdb)
18849
18850 (gdb)
18851 -exec-interrupt
18852 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18853 (gdb)
18854 @end smallexample
18855
18856
18857 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18858 @findex -exec-next
18859
18860 @subsubheading Synopsis
18861
18862 @smallexample
18863 -exec-next
18864 @end smallexample
18865
18866 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18867 of the next source line is reached.
18868
18869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18870
18871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18872
18873 @subsubheading Example
18874
18875 @smallexample
18876 -exec-next
18877 ^running
18878 (gdb)
18879 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18880 (gdb)
18881 @end smallexample
18882
18883
18884 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18885 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18886
18887 @subsubheading Synopsis
18888
18889 @smallexample
18890 -exec-next-instruction
18891 @end smallexample
18892
18893 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18894 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18895 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18896 printed as well.
18897
18898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18899
18900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18901
18902 @subsubheading Example
18903
18904 @smallexample
18905 (gdb)
18906 -exec-next-instruction
18907 ^running
18908
18909 (gdb)
18910 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18911 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18912 (gdb)
18913 @end smallexample
18914
18915
18916 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18917 @findex -exec-return
18918
18919 @subsubheading Synopsis
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 -exec-return
18923 @end smallexample
18924
18925 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18926 Displays the new current frame.
18927
18928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18929
18930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18931
18932 @subsubheading Example
18933
18934 @smallexample
18935 (gdb)
18936 200-break-insert callee4
18937 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18938 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18939 (gdb)
18940 000-exec-run
18941 000^running
18942 (gdb)
18943 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18944 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18946 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18947 (gdb)
18948 205-break-delete
18949 205^done
18950 (gdb)
18951 111-exec-return
18952 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18953 args=[@{name="strarg",
18954 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18955 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18956 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18957 (gdb)
18958 @end smallexample
18959
18960
18961 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18962 @findex -exec-run
18963
18964 @subsubheading Synopsis
18965
18966 @smallexample
18967 -exec-run
18968 @end smallexample
18969
18970 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18971 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18972 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18973 the program has exited exceptionally.
18974
18975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18976
18977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18978
18979 @subsubheading Examples
18980
18981 @smallexample
18982 (gdb)
18983 -break-insert main
18984 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18985 (gdb)
18986 -exec-run
18987 ^running
18988 (gdb)
18989 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18990 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18991 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18992 (gdb)
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 @noindent
18996 Program exited normally:
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 (gdb)
19000 -exec-run
19001 ^running
19002 (gdb)
19003 x = 55
19004 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19005 (gdb)
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 @noindent
19009 Program exited exceptionally:
19010
19011 @smallexample
19012 (gdb)
19013 -exec-run
19014 ^running
19015 (gdb)
19016 x = 55
19017 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19018 (gdb)
19019 @end smallexample
19020
19021 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19022 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19023
19024 @smallexample
19025 (gdb)
19026 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19027 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19028 @end smallexample
19029
19030
19031 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19032
19033
19034 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19035 @findex -exec-step
19036
19037 @subsubheading Synopsis
19038
19039 @smallexample
19040 -exec-step
19041 @end smallexample
19042
19043 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19044 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19045 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19046 function.
19047
19048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19049
19050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19051
19052 @subsubheading Example
19053
19054 Stepping into a function:
19055
19056 @smallexample
19057 -exec-step
19058 ^running
19059 (gdb)
19060 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19061 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19062 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19063 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19064 (gdb)
19065 @end smallexample
19066
19067 Regular stepping:
19068
19069 @smallexample
19070 -exec-step
19071 ^running
19072 (gdb)
19073 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19074 (gdb)
19075 @end smallexample
19076
19077
19078 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19079 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19080
19081 @subsubheading Synopsis
19082
19083 @smallexample
19084 -exec-step-instruction
19085 @end smallexample
19086
19087 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19088 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19089 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19090 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19091 well.
19092
19093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19094
19095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19096
19097 @subsubheading Example
19098
19099 @smallexample
19100 (gdb)
19101 -exec-step-instruction
19102 ^running
19103
19104 (gdb)
19105 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19106 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19107 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19108 (gdb)
19109 -exec-step-instruction
19110 ^running
19111
19112 (gdb)
19113 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19114 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19115 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19116 (gdb)
19117 @end smallexample
19118
19119
19120 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19121 @findex -exec-until
19122
19123 @subsubheading Synopsis
19124
19125 @smallexample
19126 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19127 @end smallexample
19128
19129 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19130 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19131 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19132 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19133
19134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19135
19136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19137
19138 @subsubheading Example
19139
19140 @smallexample
19141 (gdb)
19142 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19143 ^running
19144 (gdb)
19145 x = 55
19146 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19147 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19148 (gdb)
19149 @end smallexample
19150
19151 @ignore
19152 @subheading -file-clear
19153 Is this going away????
19154 @end ignore
19155
19156 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19157 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19158 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19159
19160
19161 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19162 @findex -stack-info-frame
19163
19164 @subsubheading Synopsis
19165
19166 @smallexample
19167 -stack-info-frame
19168 @end smallexample
19169
19170 Get info on the selected frame.
19171
19172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19173
19174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19175 (without arguments).
19176
19177 @subsubheading Example
19178
19179 @smallexample
19180 (gdb)
19181 -stack-info-frame
19182 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19183 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19184 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19185 (gdb)
19186 @end smallexample
19187
19188 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19189 @findex -stack-info-depth
19190
19191 @subsubheading Synopsis
19192
19193 @smallexample
19194 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19195 @end smallexample
19196
19197 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19198 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19199
19200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19201
19202 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19203
19204 @subsubheading Example
19205
19206 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19207
19208 @smallexample
19209 (gdb)
19210 -stack-info-depth
19211 ^done,depth="12"
19212 (gdb)
19213 -stack-info-depth 4
19214 ^done,depth="4"
19215 (gdb)
19216 -stack-info-depth 12
19217 ^done,depth="12"
19218 (gdb)
19219 -stack-info-depth 11
19220 ^done,depth="11"
19221 (gdb)
19222 -stack-info-depth 13
19223 ^done,depth="12"
19224 (gdb)
19225 @end smallexample
19226
19227 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19228 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19229
19230 @subsubheading Synopsis
19231
19232 @smallexample
19233 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19234 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19235 @end smallexample
19236
19237 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19238 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19239 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19240 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19241 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19242 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19243 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19244 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19245
19246 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19247 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19248 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19249
19250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19251
19252 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19253 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19254 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19255
19256 @subsubheading Example
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 (gdb)
19260 -stack-list-frames
19261 ^done,
19262 stack=[
19263 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19264 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19265 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19266 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19267 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19268 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19269 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19270 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19271 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19272 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19273 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19274 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19275 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19276 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19277 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19278 (gdb)
19279 -stack-list-arguments 0
19280 ^done,
19281 stack-args=[
19282 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19283 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19284 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19285 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19286 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19287 (gdb)
19288 -stack-list-arguments 1
19289 ^done,
19290 stack-args=[
19291 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19292 frame=@{level="1",
19293 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19294 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19295 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19296 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19297 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19298 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19299 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19300 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19301 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19302 (gdb)
19303 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19304 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19305 (gdb)
19306 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19307 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19308 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19309 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19310 (gdb)
19311 @end smallexample
19312
19313 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19314
19315
19316 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19317 @findex -stack-list-frames
19318
19319 @subsubheading Synopsis
19320
19321 @smallexample
19322 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19323 @end smallexample
19324
19325 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19326 following info:
19327
19328 @table @samp
19329 @item @var{level}
19330 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19331 @item @var{addr}
19332 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19333 @item @var{func}
19334 Function name.
19335 @item @var{file}
19336 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19337 @item @var{line}
19338 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19339 @end table
19340
19341 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19342 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19343 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19344 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19345 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19346 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19347 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19348
19349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19350
19351 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19352
19353 @subsubheading Example
19354
19355 Full stack backtrace:
19356
19357 @smallexample
19358 (gdb)
19359 -stack-list-frames
19360 ^done,stack=
19361 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19362 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19363 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19364 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19365 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19366 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19367 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19368 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19369 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19370 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19371 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19372 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19373 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19374 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19375 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19376 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19377 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19378 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19379 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19380 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19381 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19382 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19383 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19384 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19385 (gdb)
19386 @end smallexample
19387
19388 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19389
19390 @smallexample
19391 (gdb)
19392 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19393 ^done,stack=
19394 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19396 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19398 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19400 (gdb)
19401 @end smallexample
19402
19403 Show a single frame:
19404
19405 @smallexample
19406 (gdb)
19407 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19408 ^done,stack=
19409 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19410 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19411 (gdb)
19412 @end smallexample
19413
19414
19415 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19416 @findex -stack-list-locals
19417
19418 @subsubheading Synopsis
19419
19420 @smallexample
19421 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19422 @end smallexample
19423
19424 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19425 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19426 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19427 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19428 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19429 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19430 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19431 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19432 more detail.
19433
19434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19435
19436 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19437
19438 @subsubheading Example
19439
19440 @smallexample
19441 (gdb)
19442 -stack-list-locals 0
19443 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19444 (gdb)
19445 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19446 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19447 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19448 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19449 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19450 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19451 (gdb)
19452 @end smallexample
19453
19454
19455 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19456 @findex -stack-select-frame
19457
19458 @subsubheading Synopsis
19459
19460 @smallexample
19461 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19462 @end smallexample
19463
19464 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19465 the stack.
19466
19467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19468
19469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19470 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19471
19472 @subsubheading Example
19473
19474 @smallexample
19475 (gdb)
19476 -stack-select-frame 2
19477 ^done
19478 (gdb)
19479 @end smallexample
19480
19481 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19482 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19483 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19484
19485
19486 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19487
19488 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19489 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19490 used by @code{Insight}.
19491
19492 The two main reasons for that are:
19493
19494 @enumerate 1
19495 @item
19496 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19497
19498 @item
19499 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19500 now).
19501 @end enumerate
19502
19503 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19504 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19505 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19506 hints about their use.
19507
19508 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19509 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19510 least, the following operations:
19511
19512 @itemize @bullet
19513 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19514 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19515 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19516 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19517 @end itemize
19518
19519 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19520
19521 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19522 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19523 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19524 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19525 examining or changing its properties.
19526
19527 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19528 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19529 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19530 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19531 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19532
19533 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19534 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19535 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19536 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19537 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19538 for pointers, etc.).
19539
19540 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19541 access this functionality:
19542
19543 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19544 @item @strong{Operation}
19545 @tab @strong{Description}
19546
19547 @item @code{-var-create}
19548 @tab create a variable object
19549 @item @code{-var-delete}
19550 @tab delete the variable object and its children
19551 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19552 @tab set the display format of this variable
19553 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19554 @tab show the display format of this variable
19555 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19556 @tab tells how many children this object has
19557 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19558 @tab return a list of the object's children
19559 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19560 @tab show the type of this variable object
19561 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19562 @tab print what this variable object represents
19563 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19564 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19565 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19566 @tab get the value of this variable
19567 @item @code{-var-assign}
19568 @tab set the value of this variable
19569 @item @code{-var-update}
19570 @tab update the variable and its children
19571 @end multitable
19572
19573 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19574 how it can be used.
19575
19576 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19577
19578 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19579 @findex -var-create
19580
19581 @subsubheading Synopsis
19582
19583 @smallexample
19584 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19585 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19586 @end smallexample
19587
19588 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19589 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19590 register.
19591
19592 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19593 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19594 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19595 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19596 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19597
19598 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19599 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19600 frame should be used.
19601
19602 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19603 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19604
19605 @itemize @bullet
19606 @item
19607 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19608
19609 @item
19610 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19611
19612 @item
19613 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19614 @end itemize
19615
19616 @subsubheading Result
19617
19618 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19619 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19620 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19621
19622 @smallexample
19623 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19624 @end smallexample
19625
19626
19627 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19628 @findex -var-delete
19629
19630 @subsubheading Synopsis
19631
19632 @smallexample
19633 -var-delete @var{name}
19634 @end smallexample
19635
19636 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19637
19638 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19639
19640
19641 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19642 @findex -var-set-format
19643
19644 @subsubheading Synopsis
19645
19646 @smallexample
19647 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19648 @end smallexample
19649
19650 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19651 @var{format-spec}.
19652
19653 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19654
19655 @smallexample
19656 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19657 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19658 @end smallexample
19659
19660
19661 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19662 @findex -var-show-format
19663
19664 @subsubheading Synopsis
19665
19666 @smallexample
19667 -var-show-format @var{name}
19668 @end smallexample
19669
19670 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19671
19672 @smallexample
19673 @var{format} @expansion{}
19674 @var{format-spec}
19675 @end smallexample
19676
19677
19678 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19679 @findex -var-info-num-children
19680
19681 @subsubheading Synopsis
19682
19683 @smallexample
19684 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19685 @end smallexample
19686
19687 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19688
19689 @smallexample
19690 numchild=@var{n}
19691 @end smallexample
19692
19693
19694 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19695 @findex -var-list-children
19696
19697 @subsubheading Synopsis
19698
19699 @smallexample
19700 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19701 @end smallexample
19702 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19703
19704 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19705 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19706 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19707 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19708 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19709 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19710 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19711 and unions.
19712
19713 @subsubheading Example
19714
19715 @smallexample
19716 (gdb)
19717 -var-list-children n
19718 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19719 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19720 (gdb)
19721 -var-list-children --all-values n
19722 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19723 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19724 @end smallexample
19725
19726
19727 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19728 @findex -var-info-type
19729
19730 @subsubheading Synopsis
19731
19732 @smallexample
19733 -var-info-type @var{name}
19734 @end smallexample
19735
19736 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19737 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19738 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19739
19740 @smallexample
19741 type=@var{typename}
19742 @end smallexample
19743
19744
19745 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19746 @findex -var-info-expression
19747
19748 @subsubheading Synopsis
19749
19750 @smallexample
19751 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19752 @end smallexample
19753
19754 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19755
19756 @smallexample
19757 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19758 @end smallexample
19759
19760 @noindent
19761 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19762
19763 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19764 @findex -var-show-attributes
19765
19766 @subsubheading Synopsis
19767
19768 @smallexample
19769 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19770 @end smallexample
19771
19772 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19773
19774 @smallexample
19775 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19776 @end smallexample
19777
19778 @noindent
19779 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19780
19781 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19782 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19783
19784 @subsubheading Synopsis
19785
19786 @smallexample
19787 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19788 @end smallexample
19789
19790 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19791 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19792 for the object:
19793
19794 @smallexample
19795 value=@var{value}
19796 @end smallexample
19797
19798 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19799 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19800
19801 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19802 @findex -var-assign
19803
19804 @subsubheading Synopsis
19805
19806 @smallexample
19807 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19808 @end smallexample
19809
19810 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19811 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19812 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19813 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19814
19815 @subsubheading Example
19816
19817 @smallexample
19818 (gdb)
19819 -var-assign var1 3
19820 ^done,value="3"
19821 (gdb)
19822 -var-update *
19823 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19824 (gdb)
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19828 @findex -var-update
19829
19830 @subsubheading Synopsis
19831
19832 @smallexample
19833 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19834 @end smallexample
19835
19836 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19837 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19838 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19839 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19840 just names are printed in the manner described for
19841 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19842
19843 @subsubheading Example
19844
19845 @smallexample
19846 (gdb)
19847 -var-assign var1 3
19848 ^done,value="3"
19849 (gdb)
19850 -var-update --all-values var1
19851 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19852 type_changed="false"@}]
19853 (gdb)
19854 @end smallexample
19855
19856 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19857 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19858 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19859
19860 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19861 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19862 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19863 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19864
19865 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19866 @c @subheading -data-assign
19867 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19868 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19869 @c set variable
19870 @c @subsubheading Example
19871 @c N.A.
19872
19873 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19874 @findex -data-disassemble
19875
19876 @subsubheading Synopsis
19877
19878 @smallexample
19879 -data-disassemble
19880 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19881 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19882 -- @var{mode}
19883 @end smallexample
19884
19885 @noindent
19886 Where:
19887
19888 @table @samp
19889 @item @var{start-addr}
19890 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19891 @item @var{end-addr}
19892 is the end address
19893 @item @var{filename}
19894 is the name of the file to disassemble
19895 @item @var{linenum}
19896 is the line number to disassemble around
19897 @item @var{lines}
19898 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19899 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19900 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19901 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19902 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19903 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19904 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19905 are displayed.
19906 @item @var{mode}
19907 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19908 disassembly).
19909 @end table
19910
19911 @subsubheading Result
19912
19913 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19914
19915 @itemize @bullet
19916 @item Address
19917 @item Func-name
19918 @item Offset
19919 @item Instruction
19920 @end itemize
19921
19922 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19923 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19924
19925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19926
19927 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19928
19929 @subsubheading Example
19930
19931 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19932
19933 @smallexample
19934 (gdb)
19935 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19936 ^done,
19937 asm_insns=[
19938 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19939 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19940 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19941 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19942 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19943 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19944 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19945 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19946 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19947 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19948 (gdb)
19949 @end smallexample
19950
19951 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19952 @code{main}.
19953
19954 @smallexample
19955 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19956 ^done,asm_insns=[
19957 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19958 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19959 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19960 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19961 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19962 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19963 [@dots{}]
19964 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19965 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19966 (gdb)
19967 @end smallexample
19968
19969 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 (gdb)
19973 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19974 ^done,asm_insns=[
19975 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19976 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19977 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19978 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19979 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19980 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19981 (gdb)
19982 @end smallexample
19983
19984 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19985
19986 @smallexample
19987 (gdb)
19988 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19989 ^done,asm_insns=[
19990 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19991 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19992 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19993 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19994 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19995 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19996 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19997 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19998 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19999 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20000 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20001 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20002 (gdb)
20003 @end smallexample
20004
20005
20006 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20007 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20008
20009 @subsubheading Synopsis
20010
20011 @smallexample
20012 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20013 @end smallexample
20014
20015 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20016 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20017 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20018
20019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20020
20021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20022 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20023 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20024
20025 @subsubheading Example
20026
20027 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20028 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20029 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20030 output.
20031
20032 @smallexample
20033 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20034 211^done,value="1"
20035 (gdb)
20036 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20037 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20038 (gdb)
20039 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20040 411^done,value="4"
20041 (gdb)
20042 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20043 511^done,value="4"
20044 (gdb)
20045 @end smallexample
20046
20047
20048 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20049 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20050
20051 @subsubheading Synopsis
20052
20053 @smallexample
20054 -data-list-changed-registers
20055 @end smallexample
20056
20057 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20058
20059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20060
20061 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20062 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20063
20064 @subsubheading Example
20065
20066 On a PPC MBX board:
20067
20068 @smallexample
20069 (gdb)
20070 -exec-continue
20071 ^running
20072
20073 (gdb)
20074 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20075 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20076 (gdb)
20077 -data-list-changed-registers
20078 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20079 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20080 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20081 (gdb)
20082 @end smallexample
20083
20084
20085 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20086 @findex -data-list-register-names
20087
20088 @subsubheading Synopsis
20089
20090 @smallexample
20091 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20092 @end smallexample
20093
20094 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20095 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20096 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20097 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20098 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20099 include empty register names.
20100
20101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20102
20103 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20104 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20105 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20106
20107 @subsubheading Example
20108
20109 For the PPC MBX board:
20110 @smallexample
20111 (gdb)
20112 -data-list-register-names
20113 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20114 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20115 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20116 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20117 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20118 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20119 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20120 (gdb)
20121 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20122 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20123 (gdb)
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20127 @findex -data-list-register-values
20128
20129 @subsubheading Synopsis
20130
20131 @smallexample
20132 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20133 @end smallexample
20134
20135 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20136 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20137 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20138 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20139
20140 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20141
20142 @table @code
20143 @item x
20144 Hexadecimal
20145 @item o
20146 Octal
20147 @item t
20148 Binary
20149 @item d
20150 Decimal
20151 @item r
20152 Raw
20153 @item N
20154 Natural
20155 @end table
20156
20157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20158
20159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20160 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20161
20162 @subsubheading Example
20163
20164 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20165 don't appear in the actual output):
20166
20167 @smallexample
20168 (gdb)
20169 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20170 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20171 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20172 (gdb)
20173 -data-list-register-values x
20174 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20175 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20176 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20177 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20178 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20179 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20180 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20181 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20182 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20183 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20184 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20185 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20186 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20187 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20188 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20189 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20190 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20191 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20192 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20193 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20194 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20195 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20196 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20197 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20198 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20199 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20200 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20201 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20202 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20203 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20204 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20205 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20206 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20207 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20208 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20209 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20210 (gdb)
20211 @end smallexample
20212
20213
20214 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20215 @findex -data-read-memory
20216
20217 @subsubheading Synopsis
20218
20219 @smallexample
20220 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20221 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20222 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 @noindent
20226 where:
20227
20228 @table @samp
20229 @item @var{address}
20230 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20231 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20232 quoted using the C convention.
20233
20234 @item @var{word-format}
20235 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20236 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20237 ,Output formats}).
20238
20239 @item @var{word-size}
20240 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20241
20242 @item @var{nr-rows}
20243 The number of rows in the output table.
20244
20245 @item @var{nr-cols}
20246 The number of columns in the output table.
20247
20248 @item @var{aschar}
20249 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20250 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20251 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20252 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20253
20254 @item @var{byte-offset}
20255 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20256 @end table
20257
20258 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20259 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20260 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20261 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20262 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20263 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20264 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20265 @samp{addr}.
20266
20267 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20268 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20269 @samp{prev-page}.
20270
20271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20272
20273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20274 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20275
20276 @subsubheading Example
20277
20278 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20279 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20280 word. Display each word in hex.
20281
20282 @smallexample
20283 (gdb)
20284 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20285 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20286 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20287 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20288 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20289 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20290 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20291 (gdb)
20292 @end smallexample
20293
20294 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20295 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20296
20297 @smallexample
20298 (gdb)
20299 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20300 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20301 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20302 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20303 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20304 (gdb)
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20308 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20309 used as the non-printable character.
20310
20311 @smallexample
20312 (gdb)
20313 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20314 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20315 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20316 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20317 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20318 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20319 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20320 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20321 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20322 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20323 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20324 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20325 (gdb)
20326 @end smallexample
20327
20328 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20329 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20330 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20331
20332 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20333
20334 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20335
20336 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20337
20338 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20339
20340 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20341
20342 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20343
20344 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20345
20346 @c @subheading -trace-find
20347
20348 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20349
20350 @c @subheading -trace-info
20351
20352 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20353
20354 @c @subheading -trace-list
20355
20356 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20357
20358 @c @subheading -trace-save
20359
20360 @c @subheading -trace-start
20361
20362 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20363
20364
20365 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20366 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20367 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20368
20369
20370 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20371 @findex -symbol-info-address
20372
20373 @subsubheading Synopsis
20374
20375 @smallexample
20376 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20377 @end smallexample
20378
20379 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20380
20381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20382
20383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20384
20385 @subsubheading Example
20386 N.A.
20387
20388
20389 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20390 @findex -symbol-info-file
20391
20392 @subsubheading Synopsis
20393
20394 @smallexample
20395 -symbol-info-file
20396 @end smallexample
20397
20398 Show the file for the symbol.
20399
20400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20401
20402 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20403 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20404
20405 @subsubheading Example
20406 N.A.
20407
20408
20409 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20410 @findex -symbol-info-function
20411
20412 @subsubheading Synopsis
20413
20414 @smallexample
20415 -symbol-info-function
20416 @end smallexample
20417
20418 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20419
20420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20421
20422 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20423
20424 @subsubheading Example
20425 N.A.
20426
20427
20428 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20429 @findex -symbol-info-line
20430
20431 @subsubheading Synopsis
20432
20433 @smallexample
20434 -symbol-info-line
20435 @end smallexample
20436
20437 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20438
20439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20440
20441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20442 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20443
20444 @subsubheading Example
20445 N.A.
20446
20447
20448 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20449 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20450
20451 @subsubheading Synopsis
20452
20453 @smallexample
20454 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20455 @end smallexample
20456
20457 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20458
20459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20460
20461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20462
20463 @subsubheading Example
20464 N.A.
20465
20466
20467 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20468 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20469
20470 @subsubheading Synopsis
20471
20472 @smallexample
20473 -symbol-list-functions
20474 @end smallexample
20475
20476 List the functions in the executable.
20477
20478 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20479
20480 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20481 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20482
20483 @subsubheading Example
20484 N.A.
20485
20486
20487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20488 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20489
20490 @subsubheading Synopsis
20491
20492 @smallexample
20493 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20494 @end smallexample
20495
20496 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20497 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20498 ascending PC order.
20499
20500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20501
20502 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20503
20504 @subsubheading Example
20505 @smallexample
20506 (gdb)
20507 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20508 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20509 (gdb)
20510 @end smallexample
20511
20512
20513 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20514 @findex -symbol-list-types
20515
20516 @subsubheading Synopsis
20517
20518 @smallexample
20519 -symbol-list-types
20520 @end smallexample
20521
20522 List all the type names.
20523
20524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20525
20526 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20527 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20528
20529 @subsubheading Example
20530 N.A.
20531
20532
20533 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20534 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20535
20536 @subsubheading Synopsis
20537
20538 @smallexample
20539 -symbol-list-variables
20540 @end smallexample
20541
20542 List all the global and static variable names.
20543
20544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20545
20546 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20547
20548 @subsubheading Example
20549 N.A.
20550
20551
20552 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20553 @findex -symbol-locate
20554
20555 @subsubheading Synopsis
20556
20557 @smallexample
20558 -symbol-locate
20559 @end smallexample
20560
20561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20562
20563 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20564
20565 @subsubheading Example
20566 N.A.
20567
20568
20569 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20570 @findex -symbol-type
20571
20572 @subsubheading Synopsis
20573
20574 @smallexample
20575 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20576 @end smallexample
20577
20578 Show type of @var{variable}.
20579
20580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20581
20582 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20583 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20584
20585 @subsubheading Example
20586 N.A.
20587
20588
20589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20590 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20591 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20592
20593 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20594 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20595
20596 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20597 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20598
20599 @subsubheading Synopsis
20600
20601 @smallexample
20602 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20603 @end smallexample
20604
20605 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20606 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20607 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20608 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20609 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20610 notification.
20611
20612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20613
20614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20615
20616 @subsubheading Example
20617
20618 @smallexample
20619 (gdb)
20620 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20621 ^done
20622 (gdb)
20623 @end smallexample
20624
20625
20626 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20627 @findex -file-exec-file
20628
20629 @subsubheading Synopsis
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20633 @end smallexample
20634
20635 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20636 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20637 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20638 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20639 notification.
20640
20641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20642
20643 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20644
20645 @subsubheading Example
20646
20647 @smallexample
20648 (gdb)
20649 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20650 ^done
20651 (gdb)
20652 @end smallexample
20653
20654
20655 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20656 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20657
20658 @subsubheading Synopsis
20659
20660 @smallexample
20661 -file-list-exec-sections
20662 @end smallexample
20663
20664 List the sections of the current executable file.
20665
20666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20667
20668 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20669 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20670 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20671
20672 @subsubheading Example
20673 N.A.
20674
20675
20676 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20677 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20678
20679 @subsubheading Synopsis
20680
20681 @smallexample
20682 -file-list-exec-source-file
20683 @end smallexample
20684
20685 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20686 to the current source file for the current executable.
20687
20688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20689
20690 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20691
20692 @subsubheading Example
20693
20694 @smallexample
20695 (gdb)
20696 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20697 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20698 (gdb)
20699 @end smallexample
20700
20701
20702 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20703 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20704
20705 @subsubheading Synopsis
20706
20707 @smallexample
20708 -file-list-exec-source-files
20709 @end smallexample
20710
20711 List the source files for the current executable.
20712
20713 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20714 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20715
20716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20717
20718 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20719 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20720
20721 @subsubheading Example
20722 @smallexample
20723 (gdb)
20724 -file-list-exec-source-files
20725 ^done,files=[
20726 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20727 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20728 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20729 (gdb)
20730 @end smallexample
20731
20732 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20733 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20734
20735 @subsubheading Synopsis
20736
20737 @smallexample
20738 -file-list-shared-libraries
20739 @end smallexample
20740
20741 List the shared libraries in the program.
20742
20743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20744
20745 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20746
20747 @subsubheading Example
20748 N.A.
20749
20750
20751 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20752 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20753
20754 @subsubheading Synopsis
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 -file-list-symbol-files
20758 @end smallexample
20759
20760 List symbol files.
20761
20762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20763
20764 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20765
20766 @subsubheading Example
20767 N.A.
20768
20769
20770 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20771 @findex -file-symbol-file
20772
20773 @subsubheading Synopsis
20774
20775 @smallexample
20776 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20777 @end smallexample
20778
20779 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20780 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20781 produced, except for a completion notification.
20782
20783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20784
20785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20786
20787 @subsubheading Example
20788
20789 @smallexample
20790 (gdb)
20791 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20792 ^done
20793 (gdb)
20794 @end smallexample
20795
20796 @ignore
20797 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20798 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20799 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20800
20801 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20802
20803 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20804
20805 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20806
20807 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20808
20809 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20810
20811 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20812
20813 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20814
20815 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20816
20817 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20818 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20819 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20820
20821 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20822
20823 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20824
20825 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20826
20827 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20828 @end ignore
20829
20830
20831 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20832 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20833 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20834
20835
20836 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20837 @findex -target-attach
20838
20839 @subsubheading Synopsis
20840
20841 @smallexample
20842 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20843 @end smallexample
20844
20845 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20846
20847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20848
20849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20850
20851 @subsubheading Example
20852 N.A.
20853
20854
20855 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20856 @findex -target-compare-sections
20857
20858 @subsubheading Synopsis
20859
20860 @smallexample
20861 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20865 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20866
20867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20868
20869 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20870
20871 @subsubheading Example
20872 N.A.
20873
20874
20875 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20876 @findex -target-detach
20877
20878 @subsubheading Synopsis
20879
20880 @smallexample
20881 -target-detach
20882 @end smallexample
20883
20884 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20885 There's no output.
20886
20887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20888
20889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20890
20891 @subsubheading Example
20892
20893 @smallexample
20894 (gdb)
20895 -target-detach
20896 ^done
20897 (gdb)
20898 @end smallexample
20899
20900
20901 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20902 @findex -target-disconnect
20903
20904 @subsubheading Synopsis
20905
20906 @example
20907 -target-disconnect
20908 @end example
20909
20910 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20911 generally not resumed.
20912
20913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20914
20915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20916
20917 @subsubheading Example
20918
20919 @smallexample
20920 (gdb)
20921 -target-disconnect
20922 ^done
20923 (gdb)
20924 @end smallexample
20925
20926
20927 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20928 @findex -target-download
20929
20930 @subsubheading Synopsis
20931
20932 @smallexample
20933 -target-download
20934 @end smallexample
20935
20936 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20937 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20938
20939 @table @samp
20940 @item section
20941 The name of the section.
20942 @item section-sent
20943 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20944 @item section-size
20945 The size of the section.
20946 @item total-sent
20947 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20948 @item total-size
20949 The size of the overall executable to download.
20950 @end table
20951
20952 @noindent
20953 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20954 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20955
20956 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20957 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20958
20959 @table @samp
20960 @item section
20961 The name of the section.
20962 @item section-size
20963 The size of the section.
20964 @item total-size
20965 The size of the overall executable to download.
20966 @end table
20967
20968 @noindent
20969 At the end, a summary is printed.
20970
20971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20972
20973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20974
20975 @subsubheading Example
20976
20977 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20978 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20979
20980 @smallexample
20981 (gdb)
20982 -target-download
20983 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20984 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20985 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20986 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20987 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20988 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20989 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20990 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20991 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20992 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20993 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20994 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20995 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20996 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20997 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20998 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20999 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21000 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21001 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21002 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21003 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21004 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21005 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21006 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21007 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21008 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21009 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21010 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21011 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21012 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21013 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21014 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21015 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21016 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21017 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21018 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21019 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21020 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21021 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21022 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21023 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21024 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21025 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21026 write-rate="429"
21027 (gdb)
21028 @end smallexample
21029
21030
21031 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21032 @findex -target-exec-status
21033
21034 @subsubheading Synopsis
21035
21036 @smallexample
21037 -target-exec-status
21038 @end smallexample
21039
21040 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21041 not, for instance).
21042
21043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21044
21045 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21046
21047 @subsubheading Example
21048 N.A.
21049
21050
21051 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21052 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21053
21054 @subsubheading Synopsis
21055
21056 @smallexample
21057 -target-list-available-targets
21058 @end smallexample
21059
21060 List the possible targets to connect to.
21061
21062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21063
21064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21065
21066 @subsubheading Example
21067 N.A.
21068
21069
21070 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21071 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21072
21073 @subsubheading Synopsis
21074
21075 @smallexample
21076 -target-list-current-targets
21077 @end smallexample
21078
21079 Describe the current target.
21080
21081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21082
21083 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21084 other things).
21085
21086 @subsubheading Example
21087 N.A.
21088
21089
21090 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21091 @findex -target-list-parameters
21092
21093 @subsubheading Synopsis
21094
21095 @smallexample
21096 -target-list-parameters
21097 @end smallexample
21098
21099 @c ????
21100
21101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21102
21103 No equivalent.
21104
21105 @subsubheading Example
21106 N.A.
21107
21108
21109 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21110 @findex -target-select
21111
21112 @subsubheading Synopsis
21113
21114 @smallexample
21115 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21116 @end smallexample
21117
21118 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21119
21120 @table @samp
21121 @item @var{type}
21122 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21123 @item @var{parameters}
21124 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21125 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21126 @end table
21127
21128 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21129 which the target program is, in the following form:
21130
21131 @smallexample
21132 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21133 args=[@var{arg list}]
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21137
21138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21139
21140 @subsubheading Example
21141
21142 @smallexample
21143 (gdb)
21144 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21145 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21146 (gdb)
21147 @end smallexample
21148
21149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21150 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21151 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21152
21153 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21154
21155 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21156 @findex -gdb-exit
21157
21158 @subsubheading Synopsis
21159
21160 @smallexample
21161 -gdb-exit
21162 @end smallexample
21163
21164 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21165
21166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21167
21168 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21169
21170 @subsubheading Example
21171
21172 @smallexample
21173 (gdb)
21174 -gdb-exit
21175 ^exit
21176 @end smallexample
21177
21178
21179 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21180 @findex -exec-abort
21181
21182 @subsubheading Synopsis
21183
21184 @smallexample
21185 -exec-abort
21186 @end smallexample
21187
21188 Kill the inferior running program.
21189
21190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21191
21192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21193
21194 @subsubheading Example
21195 N.A.
21196
21197
21198 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21199 @findex -gdb-set
21200
21201 @subsubheading Synopsis
21202
21203 @smallexample
21204 -gdb-set
21205 @end smallexample
21206
21207 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21208 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21209
21210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21211
21212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21213
21214 @subsubheading Example
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 (gdb)
21218 -gdb-set $foo=3
21219 ^done
21220 (gdb)
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223
21224 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21225 @findex -gdb-show
21226
21227 @subsubheading Synopsis
21228
21229 @smallexample
21230 -gdb-show
21231 @end smallexample
21232
21233 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21234
21235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21236
21237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21238
21239 @subsubheading Example
21240
21241 @smallexample
21242 (gdb)
21243 -gdb-show annotate
21244 ^done,value="0"
21245 (gdb)
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21249
21250
21251 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21252 @findex -gdb-version
21253
21254 @subsubheading Synopsis
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 -gdb-version
21258 @end smallexample
21259
21260 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21261
21262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21263
21264 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21265 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21266
21267 @subsubheading Example
21268
21269 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21270 @c box in TeX.
21271 @smallexample
21272 (gdb)
21273 -gdb-version
21274 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21275 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21276 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21277 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21278 ~ certain conditions.
21279 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21280 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21281 ~ details.
21282 ~This GDB was configured as
21283 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21284 ^done
21285 (gdb)
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21289 @findex -interpreter-exec
21290
21291 @subheading Synopsis
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21295 @end smallexample
21296 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21297
21298 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21299
21300 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21301
21302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21303
21304 @subheading Example
21305
21306 @smallexample
21307 (gdb)
21308 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21309 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21310 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21311 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21312 ^done
21313 (gdb)
21314 @end smallexample
21315
21316 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21317 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21318
21319 @subheading Synopsis
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21323 @end smallexample
21324
21325 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21326
21327 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21328
21329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21330
21331 @subheading Example
21332
21333 @smallexample
21334 (gdb)
21335 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21336 ^done
21337 (gdb)
21338 @end smallexample
21339
21340 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21341 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21342
21343 @subheading Synopsis
21344
21345 @smallexample
21346 -inferior-tty-show
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21350
21351 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21352
21353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21354
21355 @subheading Example
21356
21357 @smallexample
21358 (gdb)
21359 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21360 ^done
21361 (gdb)
21362 -inferior-tty-show
21363 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21364 (gdb)
21365 @end smallexample
21366
21367 @node Annotations
21368 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21369
21370 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21371 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21372 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21373 relatively high level.
21374
21375 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21376 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21377
21378 @ignore
21379 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21380 @end ignore
21381
21382 @menu
21383 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21384 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21385 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21386 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21387 * Annotations for Running::
21388 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21389 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21390 @end menu
21391
21392 @node Annotations Overview
21393 @section What is an Annotation?
21394 @cindex annotations
21395
21396 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21397 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21398 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21399 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21400 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21401 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21402 cannot contain newline characters.
21403
21404 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21405 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21406 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21407 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21408 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21409 means those three characters as output.
21410
21411 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21412 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21413 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21414 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21415 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21416 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21417 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21418 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21419 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21420
21421 @table @code
21422 @kindex set annotate
21423 @item set annotate @var{level}
21424 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21425 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21426
21427 @item show annotate
21428 @kindex show annotate
21429 Show the current annotation level.
21430 @end table
21431
21432 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21433
21434 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21435
21436 @smallexample
21437 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21438 GNU gdb 6.0
21439 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21440 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21441 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21442 under certain conditions.
21443 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21444 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21445 for details.
21446 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21447
21448 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21449 (@value{GDBP})
21450 ^Z^Zprompt
21451 @kbd{quit}
21452
21453 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21454 $
21455 @end smallexample
21456
21457 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21458 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21459 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21460 output from @value{GDBN}.
21461
21462 @node Prompting
21463 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21464
21465 @cindex annotations for prompts
21466 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21467 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21468 over, etc.
21469
21470 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21471 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21472 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21473 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21474 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21475 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21476 features the following annotations:
21477
21478 @smallexample
21479 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21480 ^Z^Zprompt
21481 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21482 @end smallexample
21483
21484 The input types are
21485
21486 @table @code
21487 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21488 @findex prompt annotation
21489 @findex post-prompt annotation
21490 @item prompt
21491 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21492
21493 @findex pre-commands annotation
21494 @findex commands annotation
21495 @findex post-commands annotation
21496 @item commands
21497 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21498 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21499
21500 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21501 @findex overload-choice annotation
21502 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21503 @item overload-choice
21504 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21505
21506 @findex pre-query annotation
21507 @findex query annotation
21508 @findex post-query annotation
21509 @item query
21510 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21511
21512 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21513 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21514 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21515 @item prompt-for-continue
21516 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21517 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21518 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21519 presence of annotations.
21520 @end table
21521
21522 @node Errors
21523 @section Errors
21524 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21525
21526 @findex quit annotation
21527 @smallexample
21528 ^Z^Zquit
21529 @end smallexample
21530
21531 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21532
21533 @findex error annotation
21534 @smallexample
21535 ^Z^Zerror
21536 @end smallexample
21537
21538 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21539
21540 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21541 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21542 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21543 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21544 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21545 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21546 to the top level.
21547
21548 @findex error-begin annotation
21549 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21550
21551 @smallexample
21552 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21553 @end smallexample
21554
21555 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21556 message.
21557
21558 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21559 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21560 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21561
21562 @node Invalidation
21563 @section Invalidation Notices
21564
21565 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21566 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21567 changed.
21568
21569 @table @code
21570 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21571 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21572
21573 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21574 have changed.
21575
21576 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21577 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21578
21579 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21580 deleted a breakpoint.
21581 @end table
21582
21583 @node Annotations for Running
21584 @section Running the Program
21585 @cindex annotations for running programs
21586
21587 @findex starting annotation
21588 @findex stopping annotation
21589 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21590 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21591
21592 @smallexample
21593 ^Z^Zstarting
21594 @end smallexample
21595
21596 is output. When the program stops,
21597
21598 @smallexample
21599 ^Z^Zstopped
21600 @end smallexample
21601
21602 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21603 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21604
21605 @table @code
21606 @findex exited annotation
21607 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21608 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21609 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21610
21611 @findex signalled annotation
21612 @findex signal-name annotation
21613 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21614 @findex signal-string annotation
21615 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21616 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21617 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21618 annotation continues:
21619
21620 @smallexample
21621 @var{intro-text}
21622 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21623 @var{name}
21624 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21625 @var{middle-text}
21626 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21627 @var{string}
21628 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21629 @var{end-text}
21630 @end smallexample
21631
21632 @noindent
21633 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21634 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21635 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21636 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21637 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21638
21639 @findex signal annotation
21640 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21641 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21642 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21643 terminated with it.
21644
21645 @findex breakpoint annotation
21646 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21647 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21648
21649 @findex watchpoint annotation
21650 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21651 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21652 @end table
21653
21654 @node Source Annotations
21655 @section Displaying Source
21656 @cindex annotations for source display
21657
21658 @findex source annotation
21659 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21660
21661 @smallexample
21662 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21663 @end smallexample
21664
21665 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21666 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21667 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21668 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21669 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21670 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21671 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21672 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21673 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21674 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21675 depend on the language).
21676
21677 @node GDB Bugs
21678 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21679 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21680 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21681
21682 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21683
21684 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21685 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21686 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21687 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21688
21689 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21690 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21691
21692 @menu
21693 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21694 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21695 @end menu
21696
21697 @node Bug Criteria
21698 @section Have you found a bug?
21699 @cindex bug criteria
21700
21701 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21702
21703 @itemize @bullet
21704 @cindex fatal signal
21705 @cindex debugger crash
21706 @cindex crash of debugger
21707 @item
21708 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21709 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21710
21711 @cindex error on valid input
21712 @item
21713 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21714 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21715 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21716
21717 @cindex invalid input
21718 @item
21719 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21720 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21721 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21722 for traditional practice''.
21723
21724 @item
21725 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21726 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21727 @end itemize
21728
21729 @node Bug Reporting
21730 @section How to report bugs
21731 @cindex bug reports
21732 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21733
21734 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21735 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21736 contact that organization first.
21737
21738 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21739 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21740 distribution.
21741 @c should add a web page ref...
21742
21743 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21744 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21745 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21746 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21747 be used.
21748
21749 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21750 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21751 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21752 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21753
21754 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21755 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21756 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21757 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21758 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21759 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21760 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21761 bug reports to the mailing list.
21762
21763 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21764 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21765 fact or leave it out, state it!
21766
21767 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21768 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21769 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21770 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21771 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21772 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21773 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21774 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21775 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21776
21777 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21778 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21779 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21780 self-contained.
21781
21782 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21783 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21784 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21785 bugs properly.
21786
21787 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21788
21789 @itemize @bullet
21790 @item
21791 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21792 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21793 version}.
21794
21795 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21796 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21797
21798 @item
21799 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21800 version number.
21801
21802 @item
21803 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21804 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21805
21806 @item
21807 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21808 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21809 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21810 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21811 compilers.
21812
21813 @item
21814 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21815 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21816 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21817 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21818
21819 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21820 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21821
21822 @item
21823 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21824 reproduce the bug.
21825
21826 @item
21827 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21828 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21829
21830 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21831 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21832 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21833 a chance to make a mistake.
21834
21835 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21836 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21837 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21838 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21839 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21840 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21841 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21842 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21843
21844 @pindex script
21845 @cindex recording a session script
21846 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21847 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21848 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21849 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21850
21851 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21852 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21853
21854 @item
21855 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21856 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21857 it by context, not by line number.
21858
21859 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21860 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21861
21862 @end itemize
21863
21864 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21865
21866 @itemize @bullet
21867 @item
21868 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21869
21870 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21871 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21872 changes will not affect it.
21873
21874 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21875 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21876 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21877 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21878
21879 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21880 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21881 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21882 less time, and so on.
21883
21884 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21885 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21886
21887 @item
21888 A patch for the bug.
21889
21890 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21891 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21892 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21893 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21894
21895 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21896 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21897 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21898 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21899
21900 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21901 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21902 help us to understand.
21903
21904 @item
21905 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21906
21907 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21908 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21909 @end itemize
21910
21911 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21912 @c and consists of the two following files:
21913 @c rluser.texinfo
21914 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21915 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21916 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21917 @include rluser.texi
21918 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21919
21920
21921 @node Formatting Documentation
21922 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21923
21924 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21925 @cindex reference card
21926 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21927 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21928 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21929 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21930 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21931 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21932
21933 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21934 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21935
21936 @smallexample
21937 make refcard.dvi
21938 @end smallexample
21939
21940 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21941 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21942 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21943 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21944 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21945
21946 @cindex documentation
21947
21948 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21949 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21950 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21951 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21952 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21953 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21954
21955 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21956 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21957 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21958 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21959 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21960 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21961 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21962 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21963
21964 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21965 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21966 @code{makeinfo}.
21967
21968 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21969 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21970 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21971
21972 @smallexample
21973 cd gdb
21974 make gdb.info
21975 @end smallexample
21976
21977 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21978 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21979 Texinfo definitions file.
21980
21981 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21982 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21983 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21984 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21985 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21986 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21987 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21988
21989 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21990 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21991 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21992 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21993 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21994 directory.
21995
21996 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21997 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
21998 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21999 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22000
22001 @smallexample
22002 make gdb.dvi
22003 @end smallexample
22004
22005 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22006
22007 @node Installing GDB
22008 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22009 @cindex installation
22010
22011 @menu
22012 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22013 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22014 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22015 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22016 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22017 @end menu
22018
22019 @node Requirements
22020 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22021 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22022
22023 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22024 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22025
22026 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22027 @table @asis
22028 @item ISO C90 compiler
22029 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22030 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22031
22032 @end table
22033
22034 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22035 @table @asis
22036 @item Expat
22037 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22038 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22039 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22040 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22041 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22042 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22043
22044 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22045 features.
22046
22047 @end table
22048
22049 @node Running Configure
22050 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22051 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22052 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22053 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22054 build the @code{gdb} program.
22055 @iftex
22056 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22057 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22058 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22059 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22060 @end iftex
22061
22062 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22063 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22064 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22065
22066 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22067 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22068
22069 @table @code
22070 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22071 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22072
22073 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22074 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22075
22076 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22077 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22078
22079 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22080 @sc{gnu} include files
22081
22082 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22083 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22084
22085 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22086 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22087
22088 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22089 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22090
22091 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22092 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22093
22094 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22095 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22096 @end table
22097
22098 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22099 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22100 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22101
22102 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22103 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22104 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22105 argument.
22106
22107 For example:
22108
22109 @smallexample
22110 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22111 ./configure @var{host}
22112 make
22113 @end smallexample
22114
22115 @noindent
22116 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22117 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22118 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22119 correct value by examining your system.)
22120
22121 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22122 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22123 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22124 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22125
22126 @need 750
22127 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22128 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22129 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22130
22131 @smallexample
22132 sh configure @var{host}
22133 @end smallexample
22134
22135 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22136 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22137 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22138 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22139 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22140
22141 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22142 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22143 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22144 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22145 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22146 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22147 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22148 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22149 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22150
22151 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22152 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22153 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22154 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22155 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22156
22157 @node Separate Objdir
22158 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22159
22160 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22161 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22162 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22163 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22164 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22165 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22166 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22167 program specified there.
22168
22169 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22170 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22171 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22172 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22173 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22174 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22175
22176 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22177 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22178
22179 @smallexample
22180 @group
22181 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22182 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22183 cd ../gdb-sun4
22184 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22185 make
22186 @end group
22187 @end smallexample
22188
22189 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22190 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22191 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22192 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22193 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22194 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22195
22196 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22197 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22198 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22199 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22200 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22201
22202 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22203 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22204 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22205 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22206 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22207 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22208
22209 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22210 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22211 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22212
22213 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22214 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22215 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22216 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22217 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22218
22219 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22220 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22221 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22222 with each other.
22223
22224 @node Config Names
22225 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22226
22227 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22228 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22229 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22230 of information in the following pattern:
22231
22232 @smallexample
22233 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22234 @end smallexample
22235
22236 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22237 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22238 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22239
22240 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22241 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22242 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22243 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22244 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22245 abbreviations---for example:
22246
22247 @smallexample
22248 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22249 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22250 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22251 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22252 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22253 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22254 % sh config.sub sun4
22255 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22256 % sh config.sub sun3
22257 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22258 % sh config.sub i986v
22259 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22260 @end smallexample
22261
22262 @noindent
22263 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22264 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22265
22266 @node Configure Options
22267 @section @code{configure} options
22268
22269 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22270 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22271 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22272 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22273
22274 @smallexample
22275 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22276 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22277 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22278 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22279 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22280 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22281 @var{host}
22282 @end smallexample
22283
22284 @noindent
22285 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22286 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22287 @samp{--}.
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item --help
22291 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22292
22293 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22294 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22295 @file{@var{dir}}.
22296
22297 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22298 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22299 @file{@var{dir}}.
22300
22301 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22302 @need 2000
22303 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22304 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22305 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22306 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22307 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22308 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22309 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22310 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22311 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22312 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22313 @var{dirname}.
22314
22315 @item --norecursion
22316 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22317 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22318
22319 @item --target=@var{target}
22320 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22321 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22322 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22323
22324 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22325
22326 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22327 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22328
22329 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22330 @end table
22331
22332 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22333 needed for special purposes only.
22334
22335 @node Maintenance Commands
22336 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22337 @cindex maintenance commands
22338 @cindex internal commands
22339
22340 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22341 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22342 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22343 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22344 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22345
22346 @table @code
22347 @kindex maint agent
22348 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22349 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22350 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22351 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22352
22353 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22354 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22355 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22356 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22357 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22358 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22359 is shown:
22360
22361 @table @code
22362 @item breakpoint
22363 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22364
22365 @item watchpoint
22366 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22367
22368 @item longjmp
22369 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22370 @code{longjmp} calls.
22371
22372 @item longjmp resume
22373 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22374
22375 @item until
22376 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22377
22378 @item finish
22379 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22380
22381 @item shlib events
22382 Shared library events.
22383
22384 @end table
22385
22386 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22387 @item maint check-symtabs
22388 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22389
22390 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22391 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22392 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22393
22394 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22395 @item maint cplus namespace
22396 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22397
22398 @kindex maint demangle
22399 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22400 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22401
22402 @kindex maint deprecate
22403 @kindex maint undeprecate
22404 @cindex deprecated commands
22405 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22406 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22407 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22408 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22409 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22410 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22411 the replacement as part of the warning.
22412
22413 @kindex maint dump-me
22414 @item maint dump-me
22415 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22416 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22417 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22418 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22419
22420 @kindex maint internal-error
22421 @kindex maint internal-warning
22422 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22423 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22424 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22425 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22426 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22427 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22428 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22429 @value{GDBN} session.
22430
22431 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22432 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22433
22434 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22435
22436 @smallexample
22437 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22438 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22439 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22440 debugging may prove unreliable.
22441 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22442 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22443 (@value{GDBP})
22444 @end smallexample
22445
22446 @kindex maint packet
22447 @item maint packet @var{text}
22448 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22449 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22450 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22451 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22452 checksum.
22453
22454 @kindex maint print architecture
22455 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22456 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22457 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22458
22459 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22460 @item maint print dummy-frames
22461 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22462
22463 @smallexample
22464 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22465 @dots{}
22466 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22467 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22468 58 return (a + b);
22469 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22470 @dots{}
22471 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22472 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22473 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22474 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22475 (@value{GDBP})
22476 @end smallexample
22477
22478 Takes an optional file parameter.
22479
22480 @kindex maint print registers
22481 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22482 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22483 @kindex maint print register-groups
22484 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22485 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22486 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22487 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22488 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22489
22490 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22491 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22492 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22493 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22494 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22495 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22496
22497 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22498 write the information.
22499
22500 @kindex maint print reggroups
22501 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22502 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22503 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22504 information.
22505
22506 The register groups info looks like this:
22507
22508 @smallexample
22509 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22510 Group Type
22511 general user
22512 float user
22513 all user
22514 vector user
22515 system user
22516 save internal
22517 restore internal
22518 @end smallexample
22519
22520 @kindex flushregs
22521 @item flushregs
22522 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22523
22524 @kindex maint print objfiles
22525 @cindex info for known object files
22526 @item maint print objfiles
22527 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22528 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22529 and symtabs.
22530
22531 @kindex maint print statistics
22532 @cindex bcache statistics
22533 @item maint print statistics
22534 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22535 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22536 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22537 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22538 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22539 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22540 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22541 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22542 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22543 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22544 lengths.
22545
22546 @kindex maint print type
22547 @cindex type chain of a data type
22548 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22549 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22550 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22551 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22552 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22553 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22554
22555 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22556 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22557 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22558 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22559 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22560
22561 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22562 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22563 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22564 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22565 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22566 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22567 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22568 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22569 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22570
22571 @kindex maint set profile
22572 @kindex maint show profile
22573 @cindex profiling GDB
22574 @item maint set profile
22575 @itemx maint show profile
22576 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22577
22578 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22579 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22580 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22581 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22582 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22583 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22584 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22585
22586 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22587 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22588
22589 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22590 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22591 @item maint show-debug-regs
22592 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22593 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22594 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22595 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22596 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22597
22598 @kindex maint space
22599 @cindex memory used by commands
22600 @item maint space
22601 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22602 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22603 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22604 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22605 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22606
22607 @kindex maint time
22608 @cindex time of command execution
22609 @item maint time
22610 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22611 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22612 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22613 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22614 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22615
22616 @kindex maint translate-address
22617 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22618 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22619 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22620 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22621 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22622 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22623 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22624
22625 @end table
22626
22627 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22628 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22629
22630 @table @code
22631 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22632 @kindex set watchdog
22633 @cindex watchdog timer
22634 @cindex timeout for commands
22635 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22636 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22637 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22638
22639 @item show watchdog
22640 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22641 @end table
22642
22643 @node Remote Protocol
22644 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22645
22646 @menu
22647 * Overview::
22648 * Packets::
22649 * Stop Reply Packets::
22650 * General Query Packets::
22651 * Register Packet Format::
22652 * Tracepoint Packets::
22653 * Interrupts::
22654 * Examples::
22655 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22656 * Memory map format::
22657 @end menu
22658
22659 @node Overview
22660 @section Overview
22661
22662 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22663 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22664 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22665 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22666
22667 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22668 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22669
22670 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22671 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22672 @cindex remote serial protocol
22673 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22674 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22675 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22676 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22677
22678 @smallexample
22679 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22680 @end smallexample
22681 @noindent
22682
22683 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22684 @noindent
22685 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22686 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22687 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22688
22689 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22690 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22691
22692 @smallexample
22693 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22694 @end smallexample
22695
22696 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22697 @noindent
22698 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22699 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22700 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22701
22702 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22703 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22704 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22705 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22706 retransmission):
22707
22708 @smallexample
22709 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22710 <- @code{+}
22711 @end smallexample
22712 @noindent
22713
22714 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22715 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22716 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22717 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22718
22719 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22720 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22721 exceptions).
22722
22723 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22724 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22725 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22726 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22727
22728 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22729 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22730 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22731
22732 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22733 @anchor{Binary Data}
22734 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22735 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22736 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22737 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22738 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22739 binary data.
22740
22741 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22742 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22743 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22744 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22745 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22746 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22747 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22748 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22749 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22750 (described next).
22751
22752 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22753 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22754 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22755 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22756 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22757 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22758 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22759
22760 So:
22761 @smallexample
22762 "@code{0* }"
22763 @end smallexample
22764 @noindent
22765 means the same as "0000".
22766
22767 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22768 error number. That number is not well defined.
22769
22770 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22771 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22772 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22773 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22774 on that response.
22775
22776 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22777 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22778 optional.
22779
22780 @node Packets
22781 @section Packets
22782
22783 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22784 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22785 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22786 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22787
22788 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22789 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22790 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22791 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22792 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22793 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22794 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22795 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22796 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22797 @var{baz}.
22798
22799 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22800 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22801
22802 Here are the packet descriptions.
22803
22804 @table @samp
22805
22806 @item !
22807 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22808 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22809 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22810 debugged.
22811
22812 Reply:
22813 @table @samp
22814 @item OK
22815 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22816 @end table
22817
22818 @item ?
22819 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22820 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22821 step and continue.
22822
22823 Reply:
22824 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22825
22826 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22827 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22828 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22829 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22830 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22831
22832 Reply:
22833 @table @samp
22834 @item OK
22835 The arguments were set.
22836 @item E @var{NN}
22837 An error occurred.
22838 @end table
22839
22840 @item b @var{baud}
22841 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22842 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22843 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22844
22845 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22846 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22847 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22848
22849 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22850 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22851 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22852 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22853 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22854
22855 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22856 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22857 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22858 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22859
22860 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22861 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22862
22863 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22864 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22865 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22866 resume at current address.
22867
22868 Reply:
22869 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22870
22871 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22872 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22873 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22874 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22875
22876 Reply:
22877 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22878
22879 @item d
22880 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22881 Toggle debug flag.
22882
22883 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22884 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22885
22886 @item D
22887 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22888 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22889 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22890
22891 Reply:
22892 @table @samp
22893 @item OK
22894 for success
22895 @item E @var{NN}
22896 for an error
22897 @end table
22898
22899 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22900 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22901 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22902 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22903 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22904
22905 @item g
22906 @anchor{read registers packet}
22907 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22908 Read general registers.
22909
22910 Reply:
22911 @table @samp
22912 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22913 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22914 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22915 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22916 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22917 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22918 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22919 @item E @var{NN}
22920 for an error.
22921 @end table
22922
22923 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22924 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22925 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22926 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22927
22928 Reply:
22929 @table @samp
22930 @item OK
22931 for success
22932 @item E @var{NN}
22933 for an error
22934 @end table
22935
22936 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22937 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22938 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22939 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22940 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22941 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22942 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22943
22944 Reply:
22945 @table @samp
22946 @item OK
22947 for success
22948 @item E @var{NN}
22949 for an error
22950 @end table
22951
22952 @c FIXME: JTC:
22953 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22954 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22955 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22956 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22957 @c described. For example:
22958 @c
22959 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22960 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22961 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22962 @c
22963 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22964 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22965 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22966
22967 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22968 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22969 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22970 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22971 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22972 step starting at that address.
22973
22974 @item I
22975 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22976 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22977 step packet}.
22978
22979 @item k
22980 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22981 Kill request.
22982
22983 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22984 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22985 thread?)}.
22986
22987 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22988 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22989 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22990 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22991
22992 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22993 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22994 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22995 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22996 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22997 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22998 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22999 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23000
23001 Reply:
23002 @table @samp
23003 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23004 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23005 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23006 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23007 @item E @var{NN}
23008 @var{NN} is errno
23009 @end table
23010
23011 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23012 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23013 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23014 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23015 hexadecimal number.
23016
23017 Reply:
23018 @table @samp
23019 @item OK
23020 for success
23021 @item E @var{NN}
23022 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23023 written).
23024 @end table
23025
23026 @item p @var{n}
23027 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23028 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23029 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23030 register value is encoded.
23031
23032 Reply:
23033 @table @samp
23034 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23035 the register's value
23036 @item E @var{NN}
23037 for an error
23038 @item
23039 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23040 @end table
23041
23042 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23043 @anchor{write register packet}
23044 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23045 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23046 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23047 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23048
23049 Reply:
23050 @table @samp
23051 @item OK
23052 for success
23053 @item E @var{NN}
23054 for an error
23055 @end table
23056
23057 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23058 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23059 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23060 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23061 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23062 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23063
23064 @item r
23065 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23066 Reset the entire system.
23067
23068 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23069
23070 @item R @var{XX}
23071 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23072 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23073 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23074
23075 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23076
23077 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23078 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23079 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23080 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23081
23082 Reply:
23083 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23084
23085 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23086 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23087 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23088 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23089 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23090
23091 Reply:
23092 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23093
23094 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23095 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23096 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23097 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23098 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23099
23100 @item T @var{XX}
23101 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23102 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23103
23104 Reply:
23105 @table @samp
23106 @item OK
23107 thread is still alive
23108 @item E @var{NN}
23109 thread is dead
23110 @end table
23111
23112 @item v
23113 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23114 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23115
23116 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23117 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23118 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23119 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23120 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23121 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23122 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23123 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23124
23125 @table @samp
23126 @item c
23127 Continue.
23128 @item C @var{sig}
23129 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23130 @item s
23131 Step.
23132 @item S @var{sig}
23133 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23134 @end table
23135
23136 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23137 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23138
23139 Reply:
23140 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23141
23142 @item vCont?
23143 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23144 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23145
23146 Reply:
23147 @table @samp
23148 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23149 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23150 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23151 @item
23152 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23153 @end table
23154
23155 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23156 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23157 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23158 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23159 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23160 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23161 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23162 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23163 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23164 packet is received.
23165
23166 Reply:
23167 @table @samp
23168 @item OK
23169 for success
23170 @item E @var{NN}
23171 for an error
23172 @end table
23173
23174 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23175 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23176 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23177 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23178 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23179 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23180 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23181 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23182 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23183 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23184 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23185 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23186
23187
23188 Reply:
23189 @table @samp
23190 @item OK
23191 for success
23192 @item E.memtype
23193 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23194 @item E @var{NN}
23195 for an error
23196 @end table
23197
23198 @item vFlashDone
23199 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23200 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23201 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23202 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23203 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23204 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23205 request is completed.
23206
23207 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23208 @anchor{X packet}
23209 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23210 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23211 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23212 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23213
23214 Reply:
23215 @table @samp
23216 @item OK
23217 for success
23218 @item E @var{NN}
23219 for an error
23220 @end table
23221
23222 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23223 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23224 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23225 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23226 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23227 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23228 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23229 @var{length} bytes.
23230
23231 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23232 separately.
23233
23234 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23235 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23236 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23237 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23238 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23239 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23240
23241 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23242 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23243 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23244 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23245 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23246 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23247
23248 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23249 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23250 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23251 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23252 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23253
23254 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23255 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23256 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23257 target, is not defined.}
23258
23259 Reply:
23260 @table @samp
23261 @item OK
23262 success
23263 @item
23264 not supported
23265 @item E @var{NN}
23266 for an error
23267 @end table
23268
23269 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23270 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23271 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23272 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23273 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23274 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23275
23276 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23277 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23278
23279 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23280 movement.}
23281
23282 Reply:
23283 @table @samp
23284 @item OK
23285 success
23286 @item
23287 not supported
23288 @item E @var{NN}
23289 for an error
23290 @end table
23291
23292 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23293 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23294 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23295 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23296 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23297
23298 Reply:
23299 @table @samp
23300 @item OK
23301 success
23302 @item
23303 not supported
23304 @item E @var{NN}
23305 for an error
23306 @end table
23307
23308 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23309 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23310 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23311 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23312 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23313
23314 Reply:
23315 @table @samp
23316 @item OK
23317 success
23318 @item
23319 not supported
23320 @item E @var{NN}
23321 for an error
23322 @end table
23323
23324 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23325 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23326 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23327 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23328 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23329
23330 Reply:
23331 @table @samp
23332 @item OK
23333 success
23334 @item
23335 not supported
23336 @item E @var{NN}
23337 for an error
23338 @end table
23339
23340 @end table
23341
23342 @node Stop Reply Packets
23343 @section Stop Reply Packets
23344 @cindex stop reply packets
23345
23346 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23347 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23348 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23349 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23350 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
23351 numbering conventions is used.
23352
23353 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23354 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23355 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23356 components.
23357
23358 @table @samp
23359
23360 @item S @var{AA}
23361 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23362 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23363 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23364
23365 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23366 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23367 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23368 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23369 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23370 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23371 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23372 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23373 @enumerate
23374 @item
23375 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23376 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23377 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23378 two-digit hex number.
23379 @item
23380 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23381 hex.
23382 @item
23383 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23384 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23385 hex.
23386 @item
23387 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23388 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23389 future.
23390 @end enumerate
23391
23392 @item W @var{AA}
23393 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23394 applicable to certain targets.
23395
23396 @item X @var{AA}
23397 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23398
23399 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23400 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23401 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23402 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23403 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23404
23405 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23406 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23407 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23408 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23409 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23410 system calls.
23411
23412 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23413 this very system call.
23414
23415 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23416 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23417 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23418 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23419 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23420 protocol extension}, for more details.
23421
23422 @end table
23423
23424 @node General Query Packets
23425 @section General Query Packets
23426 @cindex remote query requests
23427
23428 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23429 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23430 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23431 sending information to and from the stub.
23432
23433 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23434 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23435 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23436 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23437 conventions:
23438
23439 @itemize @bullet
23440 @item
23441 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23442 @item
23443 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23444 letter.
23445 @item
23446 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23447 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23448 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23449 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23450 @end itemize
23451
23452 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23453 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23454 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23455 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23456 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23457 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23458 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23459 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23460 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23461 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23462 packet.}.
23463
23464 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23465 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23466 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23467 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23468 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23469
23470 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23471
23472 @table @samp
23473
23474 @item qC
23475 @cindex current thread, remote request
23476 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23477 Return the current thread id.
23478
23479 Reply:
23480 @table @samp
23481 @item QC @var{pid}
23482 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23483 @item @r{(anything else)}
23484 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23485 @end table
23486
23487 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23488 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23489 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23490 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23491 Reply:
23492 @table @samp
23493 @item E @var{NN}
23494 An error (such as memory fault)
23495 @item C @var{crc32}
23496 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23497 @end table
23498
23499 @item qfThreadInfo
23500 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23501 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23502 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23503 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23504 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23505 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23506 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23507 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23508 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23509 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23510
23511 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23512
23513 Reply:
23514 @table @samp
23515 @item m @var{id}
23516 A single thread id
23517 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23518 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23519 @item l
23520 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23521 @end table
23522
23523 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23524 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23525 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23526 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23527 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23528
23529 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23530 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23531 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23532 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23533 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23534
23535 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23536 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23537
23538 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23539 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23540 information associated with the variable.)
23541
23542 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23543 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23544 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23545 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23546 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23547 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23548
23549 Reply:
23550 @table @samp
23551 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23552 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23553 local storage requested.
23554
23555 @item E @var{nn}
23556 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23557
23558 @item
23559 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23560 @end table
23561
23562 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23563 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23564 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23565 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23566 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23567 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23568 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23569
23570 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23571
23572 Reply:
23573 @table @samp
23574 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23575 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23576 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23577 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23578 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23579 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23580 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23581 @end table
23582
23583 @item qOffsets
23584 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23585 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23586 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23587 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23588 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23589 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23590
23591 Reply:
23592 @table @samp
23593 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23594 @end table
23595
23596 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23597 @cindex thread information, remote request
23598 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23599 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23600 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23601
23602 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23603 (see below).
23604
23605 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23606
23607 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23608 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23609 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23610 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23611 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23612 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23613 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23614 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23615 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23616
23617 Reply:
23618 @table @samp
23619 @item OK
23620 A command response with no output.
23621 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23622 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23623 @item E @var{NN}
23624 Indicate a badly formed request.
23625 @item
23626 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23627 @end table
23628
23629 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23630 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23631 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23632 packets.)
23633
23634 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23635 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23636 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23637 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23638 @anchor{qSupported}
23639 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23640 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23641 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23642 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23643 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23644 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23645 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23646 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23647 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23648 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23649 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23650 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23651 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23652 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23653
23654 Reply:
23655 @table @samp
23656 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23657 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23658 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23659 possible forms).
23660 @item
23661 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23662 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23663 @end table
23664
23665 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23666 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23667 are:
23668
23669 @table @samp
23670 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23671 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23672 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23673 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23674 @item @var{name}+
23675 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23676 need an associated value.
23677 @item @var{name}-
23678 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23679 @item @var{name}?
23680 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23681 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23682 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23683 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23684 @end table
23685
23686 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23687 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23688 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23689 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23690 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23691
23692 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23693 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23694 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23695 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23696 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23697 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23698 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23699 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23700 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23701 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23702 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23703 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23704 all the features it supports.
23705
23706 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23707 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23708
23709 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23710 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23711 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23712 form response.
23713
23714 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23715 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23716 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23717 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23718
23719 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23720 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23721 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23722 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23723 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23724
23725 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23726
23727 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23728 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23729 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23730 @item Feature Name
23731 @tab Value Required
23732 @tab Default
23733 @tab Probe Allowed
23734
23735 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23736 @tab Yes
23737 @tab @samp{-}
23738 @tab No
23739
23740 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23741 @tab No
23742 @tab @samp{-}
23743 @tab Yes
23744
23745 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23746 @tab No
23747 @tab @samp{-}
23748 @tab Yes
23749
23750 @end multitable
23751
23752 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23753
23754 @table @samp
23755 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23756 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23757 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23758 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23759 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23760 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23761 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23762 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23763 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23764 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23765
23766 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23767 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23768 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23769
23770 @end table
23771
23772 @item qSymbol::
23773 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23774 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23775 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23776 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23777
23778 Reply:
23779 @table @samp
23780 @item OK
23781 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23782 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23783 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23784 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23785 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23786 below.
23787 @end table
23788
23789 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23790 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23791
23792 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23793 target has previously requested.
23794
23795 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23796 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23797 will be empty.
23798
23799 Reply:
23800 @table @samp
23801 @item OK
23802 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23803 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23804 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23805 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23806 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23807 @end table
23808
23809 @item QTDP
23810 @itemx QTFrame
23811 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23812
23813 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23814 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23815 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23816 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23817 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23818 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23819 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23820 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23821 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23822 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23823
23824 Reply:
23825 @table @samp
23826 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23827 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23828 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23829 the thread's attributes.
23830 @end table
23831
23832 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23833 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23834 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23835 packets.)
23836
23837 @item QTStart
23838 @itemx QTStop
23839 @itemx QTinit
23840 @itemx QTro
23841 @itemx qTStatus
23842 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23843
23844 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23845 @cindex read special object, remote request
23846 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23847 @anchor{qXfer read}
23848 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23849 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23850 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23851 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23852 additional details about what data to access.
23853
23854 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23855 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23856 formats, listed below.
23857
23858 @table @samp
23859 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23860 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23861 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23862 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23863
23864 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23865 by suppling an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23866 @end table
23867
23868 @table @samp
23869 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23870 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23871 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
23872 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23873 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23874
23875 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23876 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23877 @end table
23878
23879 Reply:
23880 @table @samp
23881 @item m @var{data}
23882 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23883 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23884 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23885 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23886 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23887 request.
23888
23889 @item l @var{data}
23890 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23891 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23892 than the @var{length} in the request.
23893
23894 @item l
23895 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23896 There is no more data to be read.
23897
23898 @item E00
23899 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23900
23901 @item E @var{nn}
23902 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23903 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23904
23905 @item
23906 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23907 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23908 @end table
23909
23910 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23911 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23912 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23913 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23914 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23915 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23916 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23917 to access.
23918
23919 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23920 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23921 specific request specifications ought to use.
23922
23923 Reply:
23924 @table @samp
23925 @item @var{nn}
23926 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23927 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23928
23929 @item E00
23930 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23931
23932 @item E @var{nn}
23933 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23934 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23935
23936 @item
23937 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23938 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23939 @end table
23940
23941 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23942 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23943 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23944 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23945 must respond with an empty packet.
23946
23947 @end table
23948
23949 @node Register Packet Format
23950 @section Register Packet Format
23951
23952 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23953 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23954 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23955 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23956 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23957 most-significant - least-significant.
23958
23959 @table @r
23960
23961 @item MIPS32
23962
23963 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23964 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23965 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23966
23967 @item MIPS64
23968
23969 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23970 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23971 as @code{MIPS32}.
23972
23973 @end table
23974
23975 @node Tracepoint Packets
23976 @section Tracepoint Packets
23977 @cindex tracepoint packets
23978 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23979
23980 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23981 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23982
23983 @table @samp
23984
23985 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23986 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23987 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23988 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23989 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23990 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
23991 tracepoint's actions.
23992
23993 Replies:
23994 @table @samp
23995 @item OK
23996 The packet was understood and carried out.
23997 @item
23998 The packet was not recognized.
23999 @end table
24000
24001 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24002 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24003 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24004 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24005 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24006 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24007 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24008
24009 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24010 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24011 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24012 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24013 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24014 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24015 tracepoint actions.
24016
24017 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24018 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24019 following forms:
24020
24021 @table @samp
24022
24023 @item R @var{mask}
24024 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24025 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24026 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24027 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24028 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24029
24030 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24031 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24032 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24033 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24034 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24035 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24036 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24037
24038 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24039 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24040 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24041 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24042 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24043 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24044 packet).
24045
24046 @end table
24047
24048 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24049 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24050 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24051 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24052 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24053 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24054 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24055 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24056
24057 Replies:
24058 @table @samp
24059 @item OK
24060 The packet was understood and carried out.
24061 @item
24062 The packet was not recognized.
24063 @end table
24064
24065 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24066 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24067 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24068 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24069
24070 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24071 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24072 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24073 one of the following forms:
24074
24075 @table @samp
24076 @item F @var{f}
24077 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24078 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24079 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24080
24081 @item T @var{t}
24082 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24083 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24084
24085 @end table
24086
24087 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24088 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24089 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24090 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24091
24092 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24093 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24094 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24095 is a hexadecimal number.
24096
24097 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24098 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24099 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24100 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24101 numbers.
24102
24103 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24104 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24105 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24106
24107 @item QTStart
24108 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24109 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24110
24111 @item QTStop
24112 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24113
24114 @item QTinit
24115 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24116
24117 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24118 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24119 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24120 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24121
24122 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24123 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24124 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24125 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24126
24127 @item qTStatus
24128 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24129
24130 Replies:
24131 @table @samp
24132 @item T0
24133 There is no trace experiment running.
24134 @item T1
24135 There is a trace experiment running.
24136 @end table
24137
24138 @end table
24139
24140
24141 @node Interrupts
24142 @section Interrupts
24143 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24144
24145 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24146 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24147 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24148 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24149
24150 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24151 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24152 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24153 interfaces.
24154
24155 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24156 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24157 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24158 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24159 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24160 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24161 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24162 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24163
24164 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24165 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24166 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24167 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24168 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24169 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24170 program is stopped will be discarded.
24171
24172 @node Examples
24173 @section Examples
24174
24175 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24176 does not get any direct output:
24177
24178 @smallexample
24179 -> @code{R00}
24180 <- @code{+}
24181 @emph{target restarts}
24182 -> @code{?}
24183 <- @code{+}
24184 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24185 -> @code{+}
24186 @end smallexample
24187
24188 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24189
24190 @smallexample
24191 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24192 <- @code{+}
24193 -> @code{s}
24194 <- @code{+}
24195 @emph{time passes}
24196 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24197 -> @code{+}
24198 -> @code{g}
24199 <- @code{+}
24200 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24201 -> @code{+}
24202 @end smallexample
24203
24204 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24205 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24206 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24207
24208 @menu
24209 * File-I/O Overview::
24210 * Protocol basics::
24211 * The F request packet::
24212 * The F reply packet::
24213 * The Ctrl-C message::
24214 * Console I/O::
24215 * List of supported calls::
24216 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24217 * Constants::
24218 * File-I/O Examples::
24219 @end menu
24220
24221 @node File-I/O Overview
24222 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24223 @cindex file-i/o overview
24224
24225 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24226 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24227 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24228 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24229 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24230 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24231
24232 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24233 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24234 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24235 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24236 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24237
24238 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24239 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24240 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24241 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24242 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24243 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24244 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24245
24246 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24247 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24248 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24249 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24250 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24251
24252 @smallexample
24253 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24254 <- target requests 'system call X'
24255 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24256 -> GDB returns result
24257 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24258 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24259 @end smallexample
24260
24261 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24262 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24263 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24264 system are not supported by this protocol.
24265
24266 @node Protocol basics
24267 @subsection Protocol basics
24268 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24269
24270 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24271 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24272 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24273 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24274 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24275 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24276 to call the appropriate host system call:
24277
24278 @itemize @bullet
24279 @item
24280 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24281
24282 @item
24283 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24284 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24285 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24286 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24287
24288 @end itemize
24289
24290 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24291
24292 @itemize @bullet
24293 @item
24294 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24295 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24296 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24297 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24298 packet.
24299
24300 @item
24301 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24302 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24303
24304 @item
24305 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24306
24307 @item
24308 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24309
24310 @item
24311 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24312 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24313 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24314 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24315 packet.
24316
24317 @end itemize
24318
24319 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24320 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24321
24322 @itemize @bullet
24323 @item
24324 Return value.
24325
24326 @item
24327 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24328
24329 @item
24330 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24331
24332 @end itemize
24333
24334 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24335 the latest continue or step action.
24336
24337 @node The F request packet
24338 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24339 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24340 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24341
24342 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24343
24344 @table @samp
24345 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24346
24347 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24348 This is just the name of the function.
24349
24350 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24351 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24352 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24353 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24354 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24355 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24356 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24357
24358 @end table
24359
24360
24361
24362 @node The F reply packet
24363 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24364 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24365 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24366
24367 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24368
24369 @table @samp
24370
24371 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24372
24373 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24374
24375 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24376 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24377
24378 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24379 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24380 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24381
24382 @smallexample
24383 F0,0,C
24384 @end smallexample
24385
24386 @noindent
24387 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24388
24389 @smallexample
24390 F-1,4,C
24391 @end smallexample
24392
24393 @noindent
24394 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24395
24396 @end table
24397
24398
24399 @node The Ctrl-C message
24400 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24401 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24402
24403 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24404 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24405 the target should behave as if it had
24406 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24407 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24408 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24409 packet.
24410
24411 It's important for the target to know in which
24412 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24413
24414 @itemize @bullet
24415 @item
24416 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24417
24418 @item
24419 The system call on the host has been finished.
24420
24421 @end itemize
24422
24423 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24424 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24425 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24426 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24427 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24428 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24429
24430 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24431 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24432 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24433 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24434 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24435 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24436 or the full action has been completed.
24437
24438 @node Console I/O
24439 @subsection Console I/O
24440 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24441
24442 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24443 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24444 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24445 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24446 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24447 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24448 conditions is met:
24449
24450 @itemize @bullet
24451 @item
24452 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24453 @code{read}
24454 system call is treated as finished.
24455
24456 @item
24457 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24458 newline.
24459
24460 @item
24461 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24462 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24463
24464 @end itemize
24465
24466 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24467 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24468 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24469 is stopped at the user's request.
24470
24471
24472 @node List of supported calls
24473 @subsection List of supported calls
24474 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24475
24476 @menu
24477 * open::
24478 * close::
24479 * read::
24480 * write::
24481 * lseek::
24482 * rename::
24483 * unlink::
24484 * stat/fstat::
24485 * gettimeofday::
24486 * isatty::
24487 * system::
24488 @end menu
24489
24490 @node open
24491 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24492 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24493
24494 @table @asis
24495 @item Synopsis:
24496 @smallexample
24497 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24498 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24499 @end smallexample
24500
24501 @item Request:
24502 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24503
24504 @noindent
24505 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24506
24507 @table @code
24508 @item O_CREAT
24509 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24510 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24511 are concerned.
24512
24513 @item O_EXCL
24514 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24515 an error and open() fails.
24516
24517 @item O_TRUNC
24518 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24519 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24520 truncated to zero length.
24521
24522 @item O_APPEND
24523 The file is opened in append mode.
24524
24525 @item O_RDONLY
24526 The file is opened for reading only.
24527
24528 @item O_WRONLY
24529 The file is opened for writing only.
24530
24531 @item O_RDWR
24532 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24533 @end table
24534
24535 @noindent
24536 Other bits are silently ignored.
24537
24538
24539 @noindent
24540 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24541
24542 @table @code
24543 @item S_IRUSR
24544 User has read permission.
24545
24546 @item S_IWUSR
24547 User has write permission.
24548
24549 @item S_IRGRP
24550 Group has read permission.
24551
24552 @item S_IWGRP
24553 Group has write permission.
24554
24555 @item S_IROTH
24556 Others have read permission.
24557
24558 @item S_IWOTH
24559 Others have write permission.
24560 @end table
24561
24562 @noindent
24563 Other bits are silently ignored.
24564
24565
24566 @item Return value:
24567 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24568 occurred.
24569
24570 @item Errors:
24571
24572 @table @code
24573 @item EEXIST
24574 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24575
24576 @item EISDIR
24577 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24578
24579 @item EACCES
24580 The requested access is not allowed.
24581
24582 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24583 @var{pathname} was too long.
24584
24585 @item ENOENT
24586 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24587
24588 @item ENODEV
24589 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24590
24591 @item EROFS
24592 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24593 write access was requested.
24594
24595 @item EFAULT
24596 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24597
24598 @item ENOSPC
24599 No space on device to create the file.
24600
24601 @item EMFILE
24602 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24603
24604 @item ENFILE
24605 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24606 has been reached.
24607
24608 @item EINTR
24609 The call was interrupted by the user.
24610 @end table
24611
24612 @end table
24613
24614 @node close
24615 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24616 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24617
24618 @table @asis
24619 @item Synopsis:
24620 @smallexample
24621 int close(int fd);
24622 @end smallexample
24623
24624 @item Request:
24625 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24626
24627 @item Return value:
24628 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24629
24630 @item Errors:
24631
24632 @table @code
24633 @item EBADF
24634 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24635
24636 @item EINTR
24637 The call was interrupted by the user.
24638 @end table
24639
24640 @end table
24641
24642 @node read
24643 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24644 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24645
24646 @table @asis
24647 @item Synopsis:
24648 @smallexample
24649 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24650 @end smallexample
24651
24652 @item Request:
24653 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24654
24655 @item Return value:
24656 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24657 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24658 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24659
24660 @item Errors:
24661
24662 @table @code
24663 @item EBADF
24664 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24665 reading.
24666
24667 @item EFAULT
24668 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24669
24670 @item EINTR
24671 The call was interrupted by the user.
24672 @end table
24673
24674 @end table
24675
24676 @node write
24677 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24678 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24679
24680 @table @asis
24681 @item Synopsis:
24682 @smallexample
24683 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24684 @end smallexample
24685
24686 @item Request:
24687 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24688
24689 @item Return value:
24690 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24691 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24692 is returned.
24693
24694 @item Errors:
24695
24696 @table @code
24697 @item EBADF
24698 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24699 writing.
24700
24701 @item EFAULT
24702 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24703
24704 @item EFBIG
24705 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24706 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24707
24708 @item ENOSPC
24709 No space on device to write the data.
24710
24711 @item EINTR
24712 The call was interrupted by the user.
24713 @end table
24714
24715 @end table
24716
24717 @node lseek
24718 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24719 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24720
24721 @table @asis
24722 @item Synopsis:
24723 @smallexample
24724 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24725 @end smallexample
24726
24727 @item Request:
24728 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24729
24730 @var{flag} is one of:
24731
24732 @table @code
24733 @item SEEK_SET
24734 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24735
24736 @item SEEK_CUR
24737 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24738 bytes.
24739
24740 @item SEEK_END
24741 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24742 bytes.
24743 @end table
24744
24745 @item Return value:
24746 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24747 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24748 value of -1 is returned.
24749
24750 @item Errors:
24751
24752 @table @code
24753 @item EBADF
24754 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24755
24756 @item ESPIPE
24757 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24758
24759 @item EINVAL
24760 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24761
24762 @item EINTR
24763 The call was interrupted by the user.
24764 @end table
24765
24766 @end table
24767
24768 @node rename
24769 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24770 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24771
24772 @table @asis
24773 @item Synopsis:
24774 @smallexample
24775 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24776 @end smallexample
24777
24778 @item Request:
24779 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24780
24781 @item Return value:
24782 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24783
24784 @item Errors:
24785
24786 @table @code
24787 @item EISDIR
24788 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24789 directory.
24790
24791 @item EEXIST
24792 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24793
24794 @item EBUSY
24795 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24796 process.
24797
24798 @item EINVAL
24799 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24800 of itself.
24801
24802 @item ENOTDIR
24803 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24804 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24805 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24806
24807 @item EFAULT
24808 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24809
24810 @item EACCES
24811 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24812
24813 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24814
24815 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24816
24817 @item ENOENT
24818 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24819
24820 @item EROFS
24821 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24822
24823 @item ENOSPC
24824 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24825 directory entry.
24826
24827 @item EINTR
24828 The call was interrupted by the user.
24829 @end table
24830
24831 @end table
24832
24833 @node unlink
24834 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24835 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24836
24837 @table @asis
24838 @item Synopsis:
24839 @smallexample
24840 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24841 @end smallexample
24842
24843 @item Request:
24844 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24845
24846 @item Return value:
24847 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24848
24849 @item Errors:
24850
24851 @table @code
24852 @item EACCES
24853 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24854
24855 @item EPERM
24856 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24857
24858 @item EBUSY
24859 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24860 being used by another process.
24861
24862 @item EFAULT
24863 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24864
24865 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24866 @var{pathname} was too long.
24867
24868 @item ENOENT
24869 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24870
24871 @item ENOTDIR
24872 A component of the path is not a directory.
24873
24874 @item EROFS
24875 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24876
24877 @item EINTR
24878 The call was interrupted by the user.
24879 @end table
24880
24881 @end table
24882
24883 @node stat/fstat
24884 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24885 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24886 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24887
24888 @table @asis
24889 @item Synopsis:
24890 @smallexample
24891 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24892 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24893 @end smallexample
24894
24895 @item Request:
24896 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24897 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24898
24899 @item Return value:
24900 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24901
24902 @item Errors:
24903
24904 @table @code
24905 @item EBADF
24906 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24907
24908 @item ENOENT
24909 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24910 path is an empty string.
24911
24912 @item ENOTDIR
24913 A component of the path is not a directory.
24914
24915 @item EFAULT
24916 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24917
24918 @item EACCES
24919 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24920
24921 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24922 @var{pathname} was too long.
24923
24924 @item EINTR
24925 The call was interrupted by the user.
24926 @end table
24927
24928 @end table
24929
24930 @node gettimeofday
24931 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24932 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24933
24934 @table @asis
24935 @item Synopsis:
24936 @smallexample
24937 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24938 @end smallexample
24939
24940 @item Request:
24941 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24942
24943 @item Return value:
24944 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24945
24946 @item Errors:
24947
24948 @table @code
24949 @item EINVAL
24950 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24951
24952 @item EFAULT
24953 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24954 @end table
24955
24956 @end table
24957
24958 @node isatty
24959 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24960 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24961
24962 @table @asis
24963 @item Synopsis:
24964 @smallexample
24965 int isatty(int fd);
24966 @end smallexample
24967
24968 @item Request:
24969 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24970
24971 @item Return value:
24972 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24973
24974 @item Errors:
24975
24976 @table @code
24977 @item EINTR
24978 The call was interrupted by the user.
24979 @end table
24980
24981 @end table
24982
24983 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
24984 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
24985 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
24986 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
24987 needed.
24988
24989
24990 @node system
24991 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
24992 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
24993
24994 @table @asis
24995 @item Synopsis:
24996 @smallexample
24997 int system(const char *command);
24998 @end smallexample
24999
25000 @item Request:
25001 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25002
25003 @item Return value:
25004 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25005 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25006 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25007 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25008 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25009 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25010 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25011
25012 @item Errors:
25013
25014 @table @code
25015 @item EINTR
25016 The call was interrupted by the user.
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @end table
25020
25021 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25022 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25023 the host is simplified before it's returned
25024 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25025 is discarded, and the return value consists
25026 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25027
25028 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25029 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25030 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25031
25032 @table @code
25033 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25034 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25035 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25036 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25037
25038 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25039 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25040 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25041 protocol.
25042 @end table
25043
25044 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25045 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25046 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25047
25048 @menu
25049 * Integral datatypes::
25050 * Pointer values::
25051 * Memory transfer::
25052 * struct stat::
25053 * struct timeval::
25054 @end menu
25055
25056 @node Integral datatypes
25057 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25058 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25059
25060 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25061 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25062 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25063
25064 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25065 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25066
25067 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25068
25069 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25070 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25071
25072 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25073
25074 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25075 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25076 byte order.
25077
25078 @node Pointer values
25079 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25080 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25081
25082 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25083 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25084 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25085 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25086
25087 @smallexample
25088 @code{1aaf/12}
25089 @end smallexample
25090
25091 @noindent
25092 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25093 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25094 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25095 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 @code{123456/d}
25099 @end smallexample
25100
25101 @node Memory transfer
25102 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25103 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25104
25105 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25106 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25107 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25108 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25109 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25110 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25111 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25112
25113
25114 @node struct stat
25115 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25116 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25117
25118 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25119 is defined as follows:
25120
25121 @smallexample
25122 struct stat @{
25123 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25124 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25125 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25126 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25127 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25128 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25129 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25130 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25131 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25132 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25133 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25134 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25135 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25136 @};
25137 @end smallexample
25138
25139 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25140 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25141 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25142
25143 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25144 range of values.
25145
25146 @table @code
25147
25148 @item st_dev
25149 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25150
25151 @item st_ino
25152 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25153
25154 @item st_mode
25155 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25156 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25157
25158 @item st_uid
25159 @itemx st_gid
25160 @itemx st_rdev
25161 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25162
25163 @item st_atime
25164 @itemx st_mtime
25165 @itemx st_ctime
25166 These values have a host and file system dependent
25167 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25168 support exact timing values.
25169 @end table
25170
25171 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25172 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25173 continuing.
25174
25175 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25176 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25177 get truncated on the target.
25178
25179 @node struct timeval
25180 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25181 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25182
25183 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25184 is defined as follows:
25185
25186 @smallexample
25187 struct timeval @{
25188 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25189 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25190 @};
25191 @end smallexample
25192
25193 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25194 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25195 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25196
25197 @node Constants
25198 @subsection Constants
25199 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25200
25201 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25202 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25203 values before and after the call as needed.
25204
25205 @menu
25206 * Open flags::
25207 * mode_t values::
25208 * Errno values::
25209 * Lseek flags::
25210 * Limits::
25211 @end menu
25212
25213 @node Open flags
25214 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25215 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25216
25217 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25218
25219 @smallexample
25220 O_RDONLY 0x0
25221 O_WRONLY 0x1
25222 O_RDWR 0x2
25223 O_APPEND 0x8
25224 O_CREAT 0x200
25225 O_TRUNC 0x400
25226 O_EXCL 0x800
25227 @end smallexample
25228
25229 @node mode_t values
25230 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25231 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25232
25233 All values are given in octal representation.
25234
25235 @smallexample
25236 S_IFREG 0100000
25237 S_IFDIR 040000
25238 S_IRUSR 0400
25239 S_IWUSR 0200
25240 S_IXUSR 0100
25241 S_IRGRP 040
25242 S_IWGRP 020
25243 S_IXGRP 010
25244 S_IROTH 04
25245 S_IWOTH 02
25246 S_IXOTH 01
25247 @end smallexample
25248
25249 @node Errno values
25250 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25251 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25252
25253 All values are given in decimal representation.
25254
25255 @smallexample
25256 EPERM 1
25257 ENOENT 2
25258 EINTR 4
25259 EBADF 9
25260 EACCES 13
25261 EFAULT 14
25262 EBUSY 16
25263 EEXIST 17
25264 ENODEV 19
25265 ENOTDIR 20
25266 EISDIR 21
25267 EINVAL 22
25268 ENFILE 23
25269 EMFILE 24
25270 EFBIG 27
25271 ENOSPC 28
25272 ESPIPE 29
25273 EROFS 30
25274 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25275 EUNKNOWN 9999
25276 @end smallexample
25277
25278 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25279 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25280
25281 @node Lseek flags
25282 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25283 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25284
25285 @smallexample
25286 SEEK_SET 0
25287 SEEK_CUR 1
25288 SEEK_END 2
25289 @end smallexample
25290
25291 @node Limits
25292 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25293 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25294
25295 All values are given in decimal representation.
25296
25297 @smallexample
25298 INT_MIN -2147483648
25299 INT_MAX 2147483647
25300 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25301 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25302 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25303 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25304 @end smallexample
25305
25306 @node File-I/O Examples
25307 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25308 @cindex file-i/o examples
25309
25310 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25311 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25312
25313 @smallexample
25314 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25315 @emph{request memory read from target}
25316 -> @code{m1234,6}
25317 <- XXXXXX
25318 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25319 -> @code{F6}
25320 @end smallexample
25321
25322 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25323 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25324
25325 @smallexample
25326 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25327 @emph{request memory write to target}
25328 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25329 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25330 -> @code{F6}
25331 @end smallexample
25332
25333 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25334 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25335
25336 @smallexample
25337 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25338 -> @code{F-1,9}
25339 @end smallexample
25340
25341 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25342 host is called:
25343
25344 @smallexample
25345 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25346 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25347 <- @code{T02}
25348 @end smallexample
25349
25350 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25351 host is called:
25352
25353 @smallexample
25354 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25355 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25356 <- @code{T02}
25357 @end smallexample
25358
25359 @node Memory map format
25360 @section Memory map format
25361 @cindex memory map format
25362
25363 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25364 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25365 memory map.
25366
25367 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25368 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25369 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25370
25371 @smallexample
25372 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25373 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25374 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25375 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25376 <memory-map>
25377 region...
25378 </memory-map>
25379 @end smallexample
25380
25381 Each region can be either:
25382
25383 @itemize
25384
25385 @item
25386 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25387 bytes from there:
25388
25389 @smallexample
25390 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25391 @end smallexample
25392
25393
25394 @item
25395 A region of read-only memory:
25396
25397 @smallexample
25398 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25399 @end smallexample
25400
25401
25402 @item
25403 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25404 bytes in length:
25405
25406 @smallexample
25407 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25408 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25409 </memory>
25410 @end smallexample
25411
25412 @end itemize
25413
25414 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25415 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25416 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25417
25418 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25419
25420 @smallexample
25421 <!-- ................................................... -->
25422 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25423 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25424 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25425 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25426 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25427 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25428 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25429 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25430 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25431 and its type, or device. -->
25432 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25433 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25434 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25435 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25436 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25437 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25438 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25439 @end smallexample
25440
25441 @include agentexpr.texi
25442
25443 @include gpl.texi
25444
25445 @raisesections
25446 @include fdl.texi
25447 @lowersections
25448
25449 @node Index
25450 @unnumbered Index
25451
25452 @printindex cp
25453
25454 @tex
25455 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25456 % meantime:
25457 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25458 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25459 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25460 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25461 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25462 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25463 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25464 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25465 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25466 \page\colophon
25467 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25468 @end tex
25469
25470 @bye
This page took 0.56932 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.